blob: d9368b938092bed4ddcd5080c5993e47bb32fd2a [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau9dc6b972019-06-16 21:49:47 +02005 version 2.1
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaudb514072019-07-16 19:15:28 +02007 2019/07/16
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200677. Using ACLs and fetching samples
687.1. ACL basics
697.1.1. Matching booleans
707.1.2. Matching integers
717.1.3. Matching strings
727.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
737.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
747.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
757.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
767.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200777.3.1. Converters
787.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
797.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
807.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
817.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
827.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200837.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200856. Cache
866.1. Limitation
876.2. Setup
886.2.1. Cache section
896.2.2. Proxy section
90
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200918. Logging
928.1. Log levels
938.2. Log formats
948.2.1. Default log format
958.2.2. TCP log format
968.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100978.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100988.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200998.3. Advanced logging options
1008.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1018.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1028.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1038.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1048.4. Timing events
1058.5. Session state at disconnection
1068.6. Non-printable characters
1078.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1088.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1098.9. Examples of logs
110
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001119. Supported filters
1129.1. Trace
1139.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001149.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001159.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200116
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117
1181. Quick reminder about HTTP
119----------------------------
120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100121When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
123on almost anything found in the contents.
124
125However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
126formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
127correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
128
129
1301.1. The HTTP transaction model
131-------------------------------
132
133The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100134to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
136connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137will involve a new connection :
138
139 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
140
141In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
142establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
143by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
144length.
145
146Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
147to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
148however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
149response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
150header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
151
152 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
153
154Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
155power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
156but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200157a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100159Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
161second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
162page :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
167latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
168correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
169the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100170server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
173time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
174are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
175parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
176carry the stream identifier.
177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100178By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
179connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
180leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
182processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
183waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200185HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100186 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
187 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100188 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200190 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200371 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200479Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
480file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200481
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200482* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
483 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
484
485* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
486 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
487 directory.
488
489* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
490
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500491* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200492 processes, separated by semicolons.
493
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500494* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200495 CLI, separated by semicolons.
496
497See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200498
4992.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200500----------------
501
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100502Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100503values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
504otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
505numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
506for every keyword. Supported units are :
507
508 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
509 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
510 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
511 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
512 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
513 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
514
515
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005162.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200517-------------
518
519 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
520 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
521 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
522 global
523 daemon
524 maxconn 256
525
526 defaults
527 mode http
528 timeout connect 5000ms
529 timeout client 50000ms
530 timeout server 50000ms
531
532 frontend http-in
533 bind *:80
534 default_backend servers
535
536 backend servers
537 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
538
539
540 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
541 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
542 global
543 daemon
544 maxconn 256
545
546 defaults
547 mode http
548 timeout connect 5000ms
549 timeout client 50000ms
550 timeout server 50000ms
551
552 listen http-in
553 bind *:80
554 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
555
556
557Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
558
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100559 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200560
561
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005623. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200563--------------------
564
565Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
566are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
567of them have command-line equivalents.
568
569The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
570
571 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200572 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200573 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200574 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200575 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200577 - description
578 - deviceatlas-json-file
579 - deviceatlas-log-level
580 - deviceatlas-separator
581 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900582 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200583 - gid
584 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100585 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200586 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100588 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200590 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200592 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200593 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200594 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100595 - presetenv
596 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - uid
598 - ulimit-n
599 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200600 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100601 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200602 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200603 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200604 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200605 - ssl-default-bind-options
606 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200607 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - ssl-default-server-options
609 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100610 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100611 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100612 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100613 - 51degrees-data-file
614 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200615 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200616 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200617 - wurfl-data-file
618 - wurfl-information-list
619 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200620 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100621
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200622 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200623 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200624 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200625 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100626 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100627 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100628 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200629 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200630 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200631 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200632 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633 - noepoll
634 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000635 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100637 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300638 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000639 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100640 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200641 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200642 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200643 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000644 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000645 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200646 - tune.buffers.limit
647 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200648 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200649 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100650 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200651 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200652 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200653 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100654 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200655 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200656 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100657 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100658 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100659 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100660 - tune.lua.session-timeout
661 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200662 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100663 - tune.maxaccept
664 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200665 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200666 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200667 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100668 - tune.rcvbuf.client
669 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100670 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200671 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100672 - tune.sndbuf.client
673 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100674 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100675 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200676 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100677 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200678 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200679 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100680 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200681 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100682 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200683 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
684 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
685 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100686 - tune.zlib.memlevel
687 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100688
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200689 * Debugging
690 - debug
691 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200692
693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006943.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200695------------------------------------
696
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200697ca-base <dir>
698 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200699 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
700 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200701
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200702chroot <jail dir>
703 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
704 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
705 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
706 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
707 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100708 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100709
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100710cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
711 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
712 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
713 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
714 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
715 set. These sets have the format
716
717 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
718
719 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100720 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100721 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
722 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100723 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
724 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100725 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100726 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100727 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100728 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100729 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
730 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
731 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
732 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100733
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100734 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
735 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
736 on the machine's word size.
737
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100738 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100739 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
740 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
741 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
742 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
743 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
744 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100745
746 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100747 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
748
749 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
750 # first 4 CPUs
751
752 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
753 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
754 # word size.
755
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100756 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100757 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100758 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
759 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
760 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
761
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100762 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
763 # and so on.
764 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
765 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
766 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
767
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100768 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100769 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
770 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
771 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
772
773 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
774 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
775 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
776
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100777 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
778 # and a thread range.
779 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
780 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
781 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
782
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200783crt-base <dir>
784 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
785 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
786 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
787
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200788daemon
789 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
790 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100791 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
792 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200793
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200794deviceatlas-json-file <path>
795 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100796 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200797
798deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100799 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200800 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
801
802deviceatlas-separator <char>
803 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
804 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
805
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100806deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200807 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
808 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
809 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100810
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900811external-check
812 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
813 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
814 See "option external-check".
815
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200816gid <number>
817 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
818 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
819 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100820 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
821 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200822 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100823
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100824hard-stop-after <time>
825 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
826
827 Arguments :
828 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
829 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
830 SIGUSR1 signal.
831
832 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
833 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
834 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
835
836 Example:
837 global
838 hard-stop-after 30s
839
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200840group <group name>
841 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
842 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100843
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200844log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
845 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100846 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100847 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100848 configured with "log global".
849
850 <address> can be one of:
851
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100852 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100853 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
854 port).
855
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100856 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
857 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
858 port).
859
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100860 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100861 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
862 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100863 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100864
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100865 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
866 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
867 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
868 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
869 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
870 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
871 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
872 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
873 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
874 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
875 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
876 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
877 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
878 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100879 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
880 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100881
882 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
883 "fd@2", see above.
884
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200885 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
886 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100887
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200888 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
889 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
890 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
891 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
892 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
893 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
894 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
895 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
896 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
897 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100898 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
899 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200900
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200901 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
902 one of the following :
903
904 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
905 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
906
907 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
908 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
909
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100910 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
911 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
912 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
913 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
914 logger consumes.
915
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100916 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
917 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
918 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
919 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
920
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200921 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
922 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
923 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
924 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
925 set with <sample_size> parameter.
926
927 <sample_size>
928 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
929 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
930 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
931 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
932 (see also <ranges> parameter).
933
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100934 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200935
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100936 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
937 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
938 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
939
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100940 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
941 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
942 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
943 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200944
945 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200946 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
947 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
948 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
949 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
950 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
951 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200952
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200953 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200954
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100955log-send-hostname [<string>]
956 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
957 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
958 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
959 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
960 the logs.
961
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000962log-tag <string>
963 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
964 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
965 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100966 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000967
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100968lua-load <file>
969 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
970 used multiple times.
971
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100972master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200973 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
974 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
975 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100976 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200977 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
978 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100979 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
980 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
981 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
982 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
983 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200984
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100985 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200986
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200987mworker-max-reloads <number>
988 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500989 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200990 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
991 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
992 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
993
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200994nbproc <number>
995 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
996 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
997 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100998 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
999 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001000 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1001 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001002
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001003nbthread <number>
1004 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001005 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1006 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1007 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1008 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1009 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001010 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1011 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1012 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1013 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1014 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1015 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1016 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001017
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001018pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001019 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001020 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1021 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1022
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001023presetenv <name> <value>
1024 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1025 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1026 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1027 and "unsetenv".
1028
1029resetenv [<name> ...]
1030 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1031 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1032 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1033 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1034 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1035 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1036 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1037 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1038
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001039stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001040 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1041 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1042 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1043 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1044 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1045 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001046 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001047 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1048 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1049 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1050 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001051
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001052server-state-base <directory>
1053 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001054 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1055 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001056
1057server-state-file <file>
1058 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1059 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1060 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1061 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1062 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1063 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1064 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1065 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001066 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1067 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001068
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001069setenv <name> <value>
1070 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1071 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1072 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1073 and "unsetenv".
1074
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001075set-dumpable
1076 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1077 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1078 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1079 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1080 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1081 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1082 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1083 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1084 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1085 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1086 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1087 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1088 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1089 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1090 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1091 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1092 expected when dying.
1093
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001094ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1095 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1096 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001097 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001098 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001099 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1100 information and recommendations see e.g.
1101 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1102 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1103 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1104 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001105
1106ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1107 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1108 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1109 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1110 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1111 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001112 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1113 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1114 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001115 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001116
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001117ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1118 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1119 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1120 keyword to see available options.
1121
1122 Example:
1123 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001124 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001125
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001126ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1127 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1128 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001129 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001130 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001131 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1132 information and recommendations see e.g.
1133 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1134 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1135 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1136 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1137 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001138
1139ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1140 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1141 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1142 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1143 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1144 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001145 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1146 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1147 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1148 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001149
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001150ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1151 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1152 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1153 keyword to see available options.
1154
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001155ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1156 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1157 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1158 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001159 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001160 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001161 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1162 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1163 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1164 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001165 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1166 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1167 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1168
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001169ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1170 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1171 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1172 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1173
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001174stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1175 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1176 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1177 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001178 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001179 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001180
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001181 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1182 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1183 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001184
1185stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1186 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1187 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001188 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001189
1190stats maxconn <connections>
1191 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1192 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1193
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001194uid <number>
1195 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1196 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1197 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1198 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1199
1200ulimit-n <number>
1201 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1202 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1203 option.
1204
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001205unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1206 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1207
1208 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1209 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1210 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1211 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1212 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1213 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1214 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1215 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1216 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1217 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1218
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001219unsetenv [<name> ...]
1220 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1221 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1222 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1223 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1224 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1225 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1226 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1227
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001228user <user name>
1229 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1230 See also "uid" and "group".
1231
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001232node <name>
1233 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1234
1235 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1236 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1237 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1238 traffic.
1239
1240description <text>
1241 Add a text that describes the instance.
1242
1243 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1244 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1245 "<" and ">" characters.
1246
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100124751degrees-data-file <file path>
1248 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001249 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001250
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001251 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001252 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1253
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000125451degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001255 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1256 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1257 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1258
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001259 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001260 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1261
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200126251degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001263 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1264 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1265
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001266 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1267 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1268
126951degrees-cache-size <number>
1270 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1271 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1272 By default, this cache is disabled.
1273
1274 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001275 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1276
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001277wurfl-data-file <file path>
1278 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1279 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1280
1281 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1282 with USE_WURFL=1.
1283
1284wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1285 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1286 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1287 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1288
1289 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1290
1291 Valid WURFL properties are:
1292 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1293
1294 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1295 device.
1296
1297 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1298 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1299
1300 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1301 particular web request.
1302
1303 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1304 used Libwurfl API version.
1305
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001306 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1307 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1308
1309 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1310 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1311
1312 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1313
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001314 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1315 with USE_WURFL=1.
1316
1317wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1318 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1319 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1320
1321 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1322 with USE_WURFL=1.
1323
1324wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1325 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1326 thus before the chroot.
1327
1328 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1329 with USE_WURFL=1.
1330
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001331wurfl-cache-size <size>
1332 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1333 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001334 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001335 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001336
1337 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1338 with USE_WURFL=1.
1339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013403.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001341-----------------------
1342
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001343busy-polling
1344 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1345 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1346 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1347 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1348 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1349 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1350 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1351 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1352 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1353 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1354 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1355 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1356 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1357 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1358 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1359 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1360 "poll" pollers.
1361
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001362max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1363 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1364 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1365 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1366 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1367 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1368 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1369 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1370 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1371
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001372maxconn <number>
1373 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1374 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1375 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001376 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1377 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1378 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1379 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001380 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1381 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1382 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1383 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1384 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1385 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001386
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001387maxconnrate <number>
1388 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1389 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1390 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1391 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1392 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1393 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1394 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1395 fairness.
1396
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001397maxcomprate <number>
1398 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001399 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001400 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1401 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1402 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001403 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001404 default value.
1405
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001406maxcompcpuusage <number>
1407 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1408 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1409 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1410 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1411 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1412 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1413 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1414 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1415
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001416maxpipes <number>
1417 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1418 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1419 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1420 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1421 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1422 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1423
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001424maxsessrate <number>
1425 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1426 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1427 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1428 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1429 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1430 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1431 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1432 fairness.
1433
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001434maxsslconn <number>
1435 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1436 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1437 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1438 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1439 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1440 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1441 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001442 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1443 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1444 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1445 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1446 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1447 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1448 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001449
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001450maxsslrate <number>
1451 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1452 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1453 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1454 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1455 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1456 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1457 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1458 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1459 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1460 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1461
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001462maxzlibmem <number>
1463 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1464 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1465 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001466 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1467 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1468 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1469
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001470noepoll
1471 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1472 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001473 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001474
1475nokqueue
1476 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1477 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1478 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1479
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001480noevports
1481 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1482 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1483 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1484 also "nopoll".
1485
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001486nopoll
1487 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1488 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001489 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001490 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1491 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001492
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001493nosplice
1494 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001495 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001496 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001497 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001498 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1499 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1500 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1501 "option splice-response".
1502
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001503nogetaddrinfo
1504 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1505 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1506
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001507noreuseport
1508 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1509 command line argument "-dR".
1510
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001511profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1512 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1513 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1514 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1515 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001516 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001517 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1518 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1519 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1520 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1521
1522 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1523 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1524 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1525 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1526 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001527 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1528 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1529 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1530 CLI.
1531
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001532spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001533 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1534 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1535 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1536 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1537 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1538 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001539
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001540ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001541 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001542 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001543 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1544 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1545 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1546 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1547 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001548 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1549 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001550 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1551 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1552 openssl configuration file uses:
1553 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1554
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001555ssl-mode-async
1556 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001557 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001558 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1559 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1560 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001561 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001562 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001563
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001564tune.buffers.limit <number>
1565 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1566 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1567 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1568 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1569 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001570 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001571 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1572 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1573 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1574 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1575 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1576 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1577 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1578 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1579 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1580
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001581tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1582 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1583 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1584 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1585 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1586
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001587tune.bufsize <number>
1588 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1589 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1590 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1591 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1592 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1593 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1594 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001595 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1596 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1597 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001598 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001599 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1600 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1601 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001602
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001603tune.chksize <number>
1604 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1605 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1606 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1607 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1608 checks whenever possible.
1609
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001610tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1611 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1612 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1613 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1614 this value. The default value is 1.
1615
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001616tune.fail-alloc
1617 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1618 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1619 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1620 gracefully.
1621
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001622tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1623 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1624 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1625 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1626 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1627 change it.
1628
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001629tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1630 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001631 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1632 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001633 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1634 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1635 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1636 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1637 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1638
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001639tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1640 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1641 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1642 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1643 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1644 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1645 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1646 recommended not to change this value.
1647
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001648tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1649 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1650 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1651 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1652 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1653 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1654 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1655 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1656
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001657tune.http.cookielen <number>
1658 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1659 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1660 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1661 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1662 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1663 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1664 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1665 to change this value.
1666
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001667tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001668 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1669 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001670 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001671 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001672 configuration directives too.
1673 The default value is 1024.
1674
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001675tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1676 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1677 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1678 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1679 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1680 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1681 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001682 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1683 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1684 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001685
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001686tune.idletimer <timeout>
1687 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1688 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1689 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1690 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1691 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1692 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001693 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001694 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001695 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1696
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001697tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1698 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1699 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1700 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1701 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1702 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1703 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1704 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1705 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1706 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1707
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001708tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1709 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001710 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001711 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1712 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001713 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001714 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1715 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1716
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001717tune.lua.maxmem
1718 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1719 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1720 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1721 memory.
1722
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001723tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1724 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001725 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1726 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001727 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001728
1729tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1730 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1731 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1732 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1733 check servers.
1734
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001735tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1736 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1737 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1738 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001739 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001740
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001741tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001742 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1743 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1744 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1745 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1746 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1747 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1748 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1749 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1750 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1751 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001752
1753tune.maxpollevents <number>
1754 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1755 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1756 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1757 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1758 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1759
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001760tune.maxrewrite <number>
1761 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1762 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1763 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1764 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1765 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1766 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1767 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1768 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1769 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1770 bufsize.
1771
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001772tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1773 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1774 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1775 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1776 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1777 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1778 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1779 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1780 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1781 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1782 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1783 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1784 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1785 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1786 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1787 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1788 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1789 setting this parameter to 0.
1790
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001791tune.pipesize <number>
1792 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1793 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1794 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1795 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1796 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1797 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1798
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001799tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1800 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1801 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1802 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1803 default is 20.
1804
1805tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1806 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1807 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1808 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1809 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1810 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1811 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001812 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001813
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001814tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1815tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1816 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1817 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1818 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001819 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001820 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001821 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1822 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1823
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001824tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001825 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001826 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1827 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1828 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1829 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1830
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001831tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001832 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001833 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1834 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1835
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001836tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1837tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1838 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1839 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1840 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001841 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001842 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001843 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1844 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1845 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1846 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1847 notifying haproxy again.
1848
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001849tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001850 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1851 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1852 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001853 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001854 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001855 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001856 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1857 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1858 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001859 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1860 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001861
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001862tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001863 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001864 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1865 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1866 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1867 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1868 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1869
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001870tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1871 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001872 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001873 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1874 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1875 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1876 being used for too long.
1877
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001878tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1879 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1880 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1881 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1882 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1883 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1884 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1885 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1886 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1887 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1888 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001889 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001890 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001891
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001892tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1893 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1894 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1895 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1896 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1897 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1898 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1899 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001900 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1901 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001902
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001903tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1904 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1905 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1906 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1907 1000 entries.
1908
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001909tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1910 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1911 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1912 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1913
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001914tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001915tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001916tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1917tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1918tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001919 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1920 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1921 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1922 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1923 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1924 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1925 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1926 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001927
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001928 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1929 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1930 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1931 all available space is consumed.
1932 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1933 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1934 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001935
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001936tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1937 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001938 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001939 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001940 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001941 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1942
1943tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1944 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1945 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001946 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1947 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001948
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019493.3. Debugging
1950--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001951
1952debug
1953 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1954 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1955 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1956 system startup.
1957
1958quiet
1959 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1960 line argument "-q".
1961
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001962
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019633.4. Userlists
1964--------------
1965It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1966http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1967it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1968
1969userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001970 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001971 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1972
1973group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001974 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001975 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1976 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1977
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001978user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1979 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001980 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1981 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001982 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1983 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1984 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1985 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001986
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001987 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1988 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1989 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1990 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1991 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1992 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1993 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1994 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1995 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001996
1997 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001998 userlist L1
1999 group G1 users tiger,scott
2000 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002001
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002002 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2003 user scott insecure-password elgato
2004 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002005
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002006 userlist L2
2007 group G1
2008 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002009
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002010 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2011 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2012 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002013
2014 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002015
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002016
20173.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002018----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002019It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2020several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2021instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2022values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2023automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2024In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2025using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2026tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2027reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2028Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2029that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2030each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002031
2032peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002033 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002034 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2035
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002036bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2037 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2038 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2039
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002040disabled
2041 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2042 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2043 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2044
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002045default-bind [param*]
2046 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2047
2048default-server [param*]
2049 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2050
2051 Arguments:
2052 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2053 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2054 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2055 details.
2056
2057
2058 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2059
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002060enable
2061 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2062
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002063peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002064 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2065 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2066 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2067 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2068 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2069 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2070
2071 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2072 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2073
2074 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2075 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2076 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2077 across all peers.
2078
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002079 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2080 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002081
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002082 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2083 "server" keyword explanation below).
2084
2085server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002086 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002087 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2088 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2089 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2090 of this "peers" section).
2091 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2092
2093
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002094 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002095 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002096 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002097 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2098 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2099 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002100
2101 backend mybackend
2102 mode tcp
2103 balance roundrobin
2104 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2105 stick on src
2106
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002107 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2108 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002109
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002110 Example:
2111 peers mypeers
2112 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2113 default-server ssl verify none
2114 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2115 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002116
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002117
2118table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2119 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2120
2121 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2122 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002123 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002124 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2125 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2126 "stick-table" keyword).
2127
2128 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2129 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2130 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2131 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2132 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2133 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2134 of the stick-table name as follows:
2135
2136 peers mypeers
2137 peer A ...
2138 peer B ...
2139 table t1 ...
2140
2141 frontend fe1
2142 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2143
2144 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2145 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2146
2147 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2148 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2149 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2150 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2151 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2152 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2153 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2154
2155 peers mypeers
2156 peer A ...
2157 peer B ...
2158 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2159
2160 backend t1
2161 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2162
2163 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2164 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2165 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2166
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090021673.6. Mailers
2168------------
2169It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2170If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2171in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2172
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002173mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002174 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2175 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2176
2177mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2178 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2179
2180 Example:
2181 mailers mymailers
2182 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2183 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2184
2185 backend mybackend
2186 mode tcp
2187 balance roundrobin
2188
2189 email-alert mailers mymailers
2190 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2191 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2192
2193 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2194 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2195
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002196timeout mail <time>
2197 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2198 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2199 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2200 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2201
2202 Example:
2203 mailers mymailers
2204 timeout mail 20s
2205 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002206
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020022073.7. Programs
2208-------------
2209In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2210master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2211managed the same way as the workers.
2212
2213During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2214sequence as a worker:
2215
2216 - the master is re-executed
2217 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2218 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2219 instance of the program
2220
2221During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2222
2223program <name>
2224 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2225 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2226 the management guide).
2227
2228command <command> [arguments*]
2229 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2230 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2231 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2232 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2233
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002234user <user name>
2235 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2236 See also "group".
2237
2238group <group name>
2239 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2240 See also "user".
2241
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002242option start-on-reload
2243no option start-on-reload
2244 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2245 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2246 program section.
2247
2248
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022494. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002250----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002251
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002252Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002253 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002254 - frontend <name>
2255 - backend <name>
2256 - listen <name>
2257
2258A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2259its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2260section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002261section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002262
2263A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2264connections.
2265
2266A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2267to forward incoming connections.
2268
2269A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2270parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2271
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002272All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2273'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2274case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2275
2276Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2277logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2278proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2279However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2280name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2281
2282Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2283and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002284bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002285protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2286modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2287arbitrary criteria.
2288
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002289In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2290a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002291the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002292
2293 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2294 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2295 between responses and new requests.
2296
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002297 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2298 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2299 client-facing connection remains open.
2300
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002301 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2302 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002303
2304The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2305frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2306following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002307weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002308
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002309 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002310
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002311 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2312 ----+-----+-----+----
2313 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2314 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002315 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2316 ----+-----+-----+----
2317 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002318
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002319
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002320
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023214.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2322--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002323
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002324The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2325limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2326they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2327limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002328marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002329option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002330and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2331with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2332specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002333
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002334
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002335 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2336------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2337acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002338backlog X X X -
2339balance X - X X
2340bind - X X -
2341bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002342capture cookie - X X -
2343capture request header - X X -
2344capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002345compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002346cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002347declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002348default-server X - X X
2349default_backend X X X -
2350description - X X X
2351disabled X X X X
2352dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002353email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002354email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002355email-alert mailers X X X X
2356email-alert myhostname X X X X
2357email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002358enabled X X X X
2359errorfile X X X X
2360errorloc X X X X
2361errorloc302 X X X X
2362-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2363errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002364force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002365filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002366fullconn X - X X
2367grace X X X X
2368hash-type X - X X
2369http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002370http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002371http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002372http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002373http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002374http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002375http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002376id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002377ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002378load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002379log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002380log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002381log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002382log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002383max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002384maxconn X X X -
2385mode X X X X
2386monitor fail - X X -
2387monitor-net X X X -
2388monitor-uri X X X -
2389option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2390option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2391option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2392option allbackups (*) X - X X
2393option checkcache (*) X - X X
2394option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2395option contstats (*) X X X -
2396option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2397option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002398-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2399option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002400option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002401option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002402option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002403option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002404option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002405option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2406option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2407option httpchk X - X X
2408option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002409option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002410option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002411option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002412option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002413option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002414option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2415option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2416option logasap (*) X X X -
2417option mysql-check X - X X
2418option nolinger (*) X X X X
2419option originalto X X X X
2420option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002421option pgsql-check X - X X
2422option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002423option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002424option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002425option smtpchk X - X X
2426option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2427option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2428option splice-request (*) X X X X
2429option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002430option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002431option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2432option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2433-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002434option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002435option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2436option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2437option tcpka X X X X
2438option tcplog X X X X
2439option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002440external-check command X - X X
2441external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002442persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2443rate-limit sessions X X X -
2444redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002445-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002446retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002447retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002448server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002449server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002450server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002451source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002452stats admin - X X X
2453stats auth X X X X
2454stats enable X X X X
2455stats hide-version X X X X
2456stats http-request - X X X
2457stats realm X X X X
2458stats refresh X X X X
2459stats scope X X X X
2460stats show-desc X X X X
2461stats show-legends X X X X
2462stats show-node X X X X
2463stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002464-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2465stick match - - X X
2466stick on - - X X
2467stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002468stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002469stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002470tcp-check connect - - X X
2471tcp-check expect - - X X
2472tcp-check send - - X X
2473tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002474tcp-request connection - X X -
2475tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002476tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002477tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002478tcp-response content - - X X
2479tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002480timeout check X - X X
2481timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002482timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002483timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002484timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2485timeout http-request X X X X
2486timeout queue X - X X
2487timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002488timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002489timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002490timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002491transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002492unique-id-format X X X -
2493unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002494use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002495use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002496------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2497 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002498
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002499
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025004.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2501---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002502
2503This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2504
2505
2506acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2507 Declare or complete an access list.
2508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2509 no | yes | yes | yes
2510 Example:
2511 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2512 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2513 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002515 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002516
2517
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002518backlog <conns>
2519 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2521 yes | yes | yes | no
2522 Arguments :
2523 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2524 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002525 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002526
2527 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2528 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2529 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2530 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2531 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2532 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2533 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2534 backlog parameter.
2535
2536 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2537 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2538 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2539
2540 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2541
2542
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002543balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002544balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002545 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2547 yes | no | yes | yes
2548 Arguments :
2549 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2550 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2551 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2552 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2553
2554 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2555 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2556 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2557 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002558 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002559 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002560 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2561 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2562 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2563 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2564 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2565 it, so that you don't worry.
2566
2567 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2568 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2569 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2570 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2571 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2572 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2573 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2574 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002575
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002576 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2577 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2578 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2579 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2580 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2581 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2582 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2583 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2584
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002585 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002586 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002587 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2588 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002589 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002590 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2591 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2592 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2593 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2594 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002595 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2596 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2597 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2598 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2599 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2600 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002601
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002602 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2603 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2604 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2605 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2606 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2607 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2608 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2609 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002610 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002611 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002612 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2613 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2614 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002615
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002616 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2617 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2618 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2619 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2620 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2621 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2622 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2623 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2624 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2625 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2626 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2627 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002628
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002629 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002630 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2631 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2632 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2633 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2634 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2635 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2636 URIs start with a leading "/".
2637
2638 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2639 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2640 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2641 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2642
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002643 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002644 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2645
2646 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002647 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2648 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002649 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2650 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2651 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2652 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002653 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002654 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2655 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002656
2657 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2658 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2659 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2660 server will receive the request.
2661
2662 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2663 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2664 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2665 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2666 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002667 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2668 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2669 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002670
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002671 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2672 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2673 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2674 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2675 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002676
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002677 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002678 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2679 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2680 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2681
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002682 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2683 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2684 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2685
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002686 random
2687 random(<draws>)
2688 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002689 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2690 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2691 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2692 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002693 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2694 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2695 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2696 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2697 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2698 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2699 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2700 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2701 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2702 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2703 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2704 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2705 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2706 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2707 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2708 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2709 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2710 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2711 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2712 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002713
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002714 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002715 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002716 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2717 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2718 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2719 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2720 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2721 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002722 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002723 used instead.
2724
2725 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2726 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2727 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2728 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2729
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002730 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2731 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2732 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2733
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002734 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002735
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002736 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002737 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2738 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002739
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002740 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2741 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2742 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002743
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002744 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002745 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002746 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2747 NTLM relies on.
2748
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002749 Examples :
2750 balance roundrobin
2751 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002752 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002753 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2754 balance hdr(host)
2755 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002756
2757 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2758 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2759
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002760 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002761 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2762 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2763 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02002764 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002765
2766 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2767 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2768 defaults to 16 kB.
2769
2770 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2771 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2772
2773 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2774 Round Robin.
2775
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002776 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002777 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2778 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2779 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2780
2781 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2782
2783 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002784 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002785 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2786 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2787 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002788
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002789 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002790
2791
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002792bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2793bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002794 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2796 no | yes | yes | no
2797 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002798 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2799 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2800 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2801 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002802 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002803 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2804 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2805 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2806 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2807 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2808 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2809 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002810 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2811 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2812 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2813 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2814 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2815 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2816 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002817 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2818 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2819 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002820 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2821 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2822 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2823 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002824 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2825 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2826 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002827
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002828 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2829 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002830 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2831 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2832 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002833 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2834 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2835 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2836 the range.
2837
2838 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2839 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2840 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2841 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2842 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2843 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2844 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002845 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002846 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002847
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002848 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002849 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002850 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2851 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2852 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2853 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2854 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2855 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2856
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002857 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2858 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2859 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2860 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002861
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002862 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2863 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2864 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2865 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2866 in a frontend.
2867
2868 Example :
2869 listen http_proxy
2870 bind :80,:443
2871 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002872 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002873
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002874 listen http_https_proxy
2875 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002876 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002877
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002878 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2879 bind ipv6@:80
2880 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2881 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2882
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002883 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002884 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002885
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002886 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2887 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2888 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2889 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2890 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2891
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002892 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002893 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002894
2895
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002896bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002897 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2899 yes | yes | yes | yes
2900 Arguments :
2901 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2902 may be used to override a default value.
2903
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002904 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002905 option may be combined with other numbers.
2906
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002907 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002908 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2909 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2910 missing from all processes.
2911
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002912 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002913 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002914 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2915 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2916 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2917 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2918 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002919 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002920
2921 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2922 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2923 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2924 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2925 and 'even' instances.
2926
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002927 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2928 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2929 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2930 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002931
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002932 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2933 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2934
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002935 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2936 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2937 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2938
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002939 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2940 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2941
2942 Example :
2943 listen app_ip1
2944 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002945 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002946
2947 listen app_ip2
2948 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002949 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002950
2951 listen management
2952 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002953 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002954
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002955 listen management
2956 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2957 bind-process 1-4
2958
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002959 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002960
2961
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002962capture cookie <name> len <length>
2963 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2965 no | yes | yes | no
2966 Arguments :
2967 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2968 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2969 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2970 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002971 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002972
2973 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2974 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2975 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2976 right if it exceeds <length>.
2977
2978 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2979 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2980 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2981 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2982
2983 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2984 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2985 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2986
2987 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2988 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2989 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002990 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2991 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2992 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002993
2994 Example:
2995 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2996
2997 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002998 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002999
3000
3001capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003002 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3004 no | yes | yes | no
3005 Arguments :
3006 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003007 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003008 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3009 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3010 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3011
3012 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3013 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3014 it exceeds <length>.
3015
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003016 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003017 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3018 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003019 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3020 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3021 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3022 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003023 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003024 environments to find where the request came from.
3025
3026 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3027 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3028 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3029 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003030
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003031 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3032 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3033 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3034 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3035 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003036
3037 Example:
3038 capture request header Host len 15
3039 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003040 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003041
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003042 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003043 about logging.
3044
3045
3046capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003047 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3049 no | yes | yes | no
3050 Arguments :
3051 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003052 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003053 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3054 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3055 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3056
3057 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3058 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3059 it exceeds <length>.
3060
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003061 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003062 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3063 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3064 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003065 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3066 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3067 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3068 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003069
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003070 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3071 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3072 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3073 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3074 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003075
3076 Example:
3077 capture response header Content-length len 9
3078 capture response header Location len 15
3079
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003080 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003081 about logging.
3082
3083
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003084compression algo <algorithm> ...
3085compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003086compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003087 Enable HTTP compression.
3088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3089 yes | yes | yes | yes
3090 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003091 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3092 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3093 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3094
3095 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003096 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3097 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3098 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003099
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003100 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003101 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003102
3103 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3104 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3105 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3106 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3107 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003108 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003109
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003110 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3111 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3112 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3113 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3114 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3115 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3116 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003117 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003118
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003119 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003120 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003121 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3122 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3123 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3124 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3125 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003126
3127 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3128 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3129 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3130 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3131 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003132 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3133 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3134 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3135 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3136 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003137 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3138 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003139
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003140 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003141 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3142 "Accept-Encoding" header
3143 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003144 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003145 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3146 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3147 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3148 "multipart"
3149 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3150 header
3151 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3152 and later
3153 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3154 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003155 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003156
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003157 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003158
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003159 Examples :
3160 compression algo gzip
3161 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003162
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003163
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003164cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003165 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3166 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003167 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003168 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3170 yes | no | yes | yes
3171 Arguments :
3172 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3173 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3174 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3175 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3176 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3177 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003178 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003179 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3180 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3181
3182 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3183 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3184 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3185 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3186 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3187 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003188 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3189 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003190 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003191 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3192 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003193
3194 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003195 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003196
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003197 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003198 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003199 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003200 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003201 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3202 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3203 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3204 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3205 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3206 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3207 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003208
3209 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3210 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3211 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3212 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3213 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3214 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3215 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3216 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3217 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003218 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003219 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3220 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3221 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003222
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003223 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3224 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3225 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003226 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3227 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3228 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3229 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003230 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3231 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3232 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003233
3234 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3235 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3236 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3237 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3238 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3239 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3240 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3241 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3242 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3243
3244 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3245 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3246 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3247 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3248 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3249 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3250 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3251 persistence cookie in the cache.
3252 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3253
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003254 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3255 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3256 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3257 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3258 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003259 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003260 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3261 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3262 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3263 they logout.
3264
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003265 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3266 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3267 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3268 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3269
3270 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3271 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3272 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3273 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3274 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3275 this attribute.
3276
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003277 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003278 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003279 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3280 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3281 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3282 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3283 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3284 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003285
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003286 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3287 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3288 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3289 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3290 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3291 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3292 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3293 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003294 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003295 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3296 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3297 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3298 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3299 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3300 the site.
3301
3302 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3303 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3304 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3305 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3306 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3307 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3308 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3309 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3310 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3311 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3312 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3313 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3314 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003315 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003316 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3317 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3318
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003319 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3320 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3321 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3322 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3323 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3324 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3325
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003326 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3327 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3328 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3329 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003330
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003331 Examples :
3332 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3333 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3334 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003335 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003336
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003337 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003338
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003339
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003340declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3341 Declares a capture slot.
3342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3343 no | yes | yes | no
3344 Arguments:
3345 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3346
3347 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3348 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3349 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3350 for use in the response.
3351
3352 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003353 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003354 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3355
3356
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003357default-server [param*]
3358 Change default options for a server in a backend
3359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3360 yes | no | yes | yes
3361 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003362 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3363 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3364 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3365 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003366
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003367 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003368 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3369
3370 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003371
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003373default_backend <backend>
3374 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3376 yes | yes | yes | no
3377 Arguments :
3378 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3379
3380 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3381 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3382 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3383 will catch all undetermined requests.
3384
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003385 Example :
3386
3387 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3388 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3389 default_backend dynamic
3390
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003391 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003392
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003393
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003394description <string>
3395 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3397 no | yes | yes | yes
3398 Arguments : string
3399
3400 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3401 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3402 it describes.
3403 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3404
3405
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003406disabled
3407 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3409 yes | yes | yes | yes
3410 Arguments : none
3411
3412 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3413 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3414 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3415 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3416 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3417 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3418 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3419
3420 See also : "enabled"
3421
3422
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003423dispatch <address>:<port>
3424 Set a default server address
3425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3426 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003427 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003428
3429 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3430 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3431 during start-up.
3432
3433 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3434 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3435 possible with normal servers.
3436
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003437 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003438 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3439 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3440 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3441 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3442
3443 See also : "server"
3444
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003445
3446dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3447 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3449 yes | no | yes | yes
3450 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3451
3452 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003453 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003454 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3455 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003456 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003457 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003458
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003459enabled
3460 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3462 yes | yes | yes | yes
3463 Arguments : none
3464
3465 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3466 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3467
3468 See also : "disabled"
3469
3470
3471errorfile <code> <file>
3472 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3474 yes | yes | yes | yes
3475 Arguments :
3476 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003477 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3478 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003479
3480 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003481 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003482 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003483 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3484 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003485
3486 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3487 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3488 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3489
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003490 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3491
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003492 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3493 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3494 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3495 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3496
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003497 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3498 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003499 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003500 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3501 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3502 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3503
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003504 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3505 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3506 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003507 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003508 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3509
3510 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3511
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003512 Example :
3513 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003514 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003515 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3516 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3517
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003518
3519errorloc <code> <url>
3520errorloc302 <code> <url>
3521 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3523 yes | yes | yes | yes
3524 Arguments :
3525 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003526 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3527 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003528
3529 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3530 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3531 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3532 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003533 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003534
3535 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3536 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3537 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3538
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003539 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3540
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003541 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3542 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3543 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3544 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003545 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003546 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3547 request.
3548
3549 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3550
3551
3552errorloc303 <code> <url>
3553 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3555 yes | yes | yes | yes
3556 Arguments :
3557 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003558 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3559 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003560
3561 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3562 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3563 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3564 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003565 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003566
3567 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3568 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3569 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3570
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003571 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3572
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003573 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3574 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3575 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3576 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003577 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003578
3579 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3580
3581
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003582email-alert from <emailaddr>
3583 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003584 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003585 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3586 yes | yes | yes | yes
3587
3588 Arguments :
3589
3590 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3591
3592 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3593 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3594
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003595 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003596 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3597 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003598
3599
3600email-alert level <level>
3601 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3602 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3603 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3604 yes | yes | yes | yes
3605
3606 Arguments :
3607
3608 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3609 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3610 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3611
3612 By default level is alert
3613
3614 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3615 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3616 for the proxy.
3617
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003618 Alerts are sent when :
3619
3620 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3621 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3622 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3623 is notice or lower
3624 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3625 and a health check status update occurs
3626
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003627 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3628 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003629 section 3.6 about mailers.
3630
3631
3632email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3633 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3634 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3635 yes | yes | yes | yes
3636
3637 Arguments :
3638
3639 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3640
3641 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3642 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3643
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003644 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3645 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003646
3647
3648email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3649 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3650 mailers.
3651 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3652 yes | yes | yes | yes
3653
3654 Arguments :
3655
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003656 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003657
3658 By default the systems hostname is used.
3659
3660 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3661 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3662 for the proxy.
3663
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003664 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3665 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003666
3667
3668email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003669 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003670 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3671 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3672 yes | yes | yes | yes
3673
3674 Arguments :
3675
3676 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3677
3678 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3679 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3680
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003681 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003682 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3683
3684
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003685force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3686 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3687 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003688 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003689
3690 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3691 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3692 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3693 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3694 marked down for maintenance operations.
3695
3696 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3697 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3698 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3699 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3700 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3701 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3702 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3703 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3704 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3705
3706 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3707 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3708 is used.
3709
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003710 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003711 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003712
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003713
3714filter <name> [param*]
3715 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3717 no | yes | yes | yes
3718 Arguments :
3719 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3720 referenced in section 9.
3721
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003722 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003723 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003724 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3725 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003726
3727 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3728 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3729
3730 Example:
3731 listen
3732 bind *:80
3733
3734 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3735 filter compression
3736 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3737
3738 compression algo gzip
3739 compression offload
3740
3741 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3742
3743 See also : section 9.
3744
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003745
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003746fullconn <conns>
3747 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3749 yes | no | yes | yes
3750 Arguments :
3751 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3752 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3753
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003754 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003755 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003756 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003757 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3758 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3759 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3760 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3761 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003762 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003763
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003764 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3765 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003766 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3767 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3768 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003769
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003770 Example :
3771 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3772 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3773 # connections.
3774 backend dynamic
3775 fullconn 10000
3776 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3777 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3778
3779 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3780
3781
3782grace <time>
3783 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003785 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003786 Arguments :
3787 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3788 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3789 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3790
3791 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3792 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003793 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003794 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3795
3796 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3797 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3798 simplify it.
3799
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003800
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003801hash-balance-factor <factor>
3802 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3804 yes | no | no | yes
3805 Arguments :
3806 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3807 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003808 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003809
3810 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3811 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3812 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3813 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3814 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3815 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3816 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3817
3818 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3819 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3820 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3821 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3822 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3823
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003824 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3825 consistent hashing mechanism.
3826
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003827 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3828
3829
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003830hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003831 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3833 yes | no | yes | yes
3834 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003835 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3836 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003837
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003838 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3839 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3840 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3841 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3842 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3843 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3844 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3845 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3846 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3847 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003848
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003849 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3850 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3851 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3852 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3853 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3854 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3855 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3856 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3857 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3858 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3859 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3860 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3861 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003862 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3863 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003864
3865 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3866
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003867 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003868 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3869 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3870 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003871 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3872 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3873 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003874
3875 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3876 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003877 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3878 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3879 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3880 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3881
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003882 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3883 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3884 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3885 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3886 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3887 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3888 parameter.
3889
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003890 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3891 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3892 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3893 used on strings.
3894
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003895 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3896
3897 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3898 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3899 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3900 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3901 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3902 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3903 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3904 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3905 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3906 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3907 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3908 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003909
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003910 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3911 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3912 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003913
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003914 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003915
3916
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003917http-check disable-on-404
3918 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003920 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003921 Arguments : none
3922
3923 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3924 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3925 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3926 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3927 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3928 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3929 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3930 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003931 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3932 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3933 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3934
3935 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3936
3937
3938http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003939 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003941 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003942 Arguments :
3943 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3944 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003945 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003946 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3947 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3948 details on the supported keywords.
3949
3950 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3951 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3952 with the usual backslash ('\').
3953
3954 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3955 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3956 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3957 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3958 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3959
3960 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003961 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003962 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3963 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3964 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3965
3966 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003967 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003968 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3969 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3970 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3971 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3972
3973 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003974 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003975 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3976 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3977 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3978 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3979 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003980 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003981 trace).
3982
3983 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003984 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003985 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3986 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3987 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3988 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3989 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003990 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003991
3992 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3993 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3994 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3995 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3996 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3997 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3998 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3999 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4000
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004001 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4002 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4003 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4004
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004005 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4006 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4007
4008 Examples :
4009 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004010 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004011
4012 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004013 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004014
4015 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004016 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004017
4018 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004019 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004020
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004021 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004022
4023
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004024http-check send-state
4025 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4027 yes | no | yes | yes
4028 Arguments : none
4029
4030 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4031 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4032 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4033 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4034 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4035
4036 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4037 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4038 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4039 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4040 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004041 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4042 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4043 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4044
4045 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4046 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4047 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4048
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004049 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4050 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4051 checked in multiple backends.
4052
4053 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4054 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4055
4056 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4057 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4058 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4059 one fails.
4060
4061 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4062 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4063 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4064
4065 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4066 server's queue.
4067
4068 Example of a header received by the application server :
4069 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4070 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4071
4072 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4073
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004074
4075http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004076 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4077
4078 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4079 no | yes | yes | yes
4080
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004081 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4082 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4083 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4084 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4085 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004086
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004087 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4088 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004089
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004090 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004091
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004092 Example:
4093 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4094 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4095 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004096
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004097 http-request allow if nagios
4098 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4099 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4100 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004101
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004102 Example:
4103 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4104 acl add path /addacl
4105 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004106
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004107 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004108
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004109 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4110 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004111
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004112 Example:
4113 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4114 acl setmap path /setmap
4115 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004116
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004117 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004118
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004119 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4120 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004121
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004122 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4123 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004124
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004125http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004126
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004127 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4128 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4129 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4130 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4131 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4132 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4133 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4134 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004135
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004136http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004137
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004138 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4139 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4140 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4141 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4142 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4143 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4144 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4145 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004146
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004147http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004148
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004149 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4150 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004151
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004152
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004153http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004154
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004155 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4156 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4157 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4158 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4159 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004160
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004161 Example:
4162 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4163 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004164
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004165http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004166
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004167 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004168
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004169http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4170 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004171
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004172 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4173 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4174 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4175 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4176 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4177 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4178 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4179 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4180 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004181
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004182 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4183 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4184 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4185 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4186 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4187 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004188
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004189http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004190
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004191 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4192 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4193 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4194 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4195 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4196 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004197
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004198http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004199
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004200 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004201
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004202http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004203
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004204 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4205 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4206 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4207 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4208 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4209 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004210
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004211http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004212
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004213 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4214 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4215 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4216 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4217 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004218
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004219http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4220 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4221 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4222 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4223
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004224http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4225
4226 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4227 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4228 pointed by <resolvers>.
4229 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4230 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4231 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4232 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4233 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4234 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4235 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4236 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4237 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4238 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4239 to 0.0.0.0.
4240
4241 Example:
4242 resolvers mydns
4243 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4244 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4245 timeout retry 1s
4246 hold valid 10s
4247 hold nx 3s
4248 hold other 3s
4249 hold obsolete 0s
4250 accepted_payload_size 8192
4251
4252 frontend fe
4253 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4254 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4255 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4256
4257 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4258 # which mean DNS resolution error
4259 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4260
4261 default_backend be
4262
4263 backend b_503
4264 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4265 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4266 # 503 error page to end users
4267
4268 backend be
4269 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4270 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4271 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4272 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4273 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4274
4275 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4276 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4277
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004278http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4279
4280 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4281 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4282 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4283 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004284 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4285 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004286
4287 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4288
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004289http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004290
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004291 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4292 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4293 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4294 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4295 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004296
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004297http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004298
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004299 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4300 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4301 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4302 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004303
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004304http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4305 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004306
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004307 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4308 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4309 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4310 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4311 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4312 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4313 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4314 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004315
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004316 Example:
4317 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004318
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004319 # applied to:
4320 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004321
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004322 # outputs:
4323 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004325 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004326
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004327http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4328 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4329
4330 This matches the regular expression in the URI part of the request
4331 according to <match-regex>, and replaces it with the <replace-fmt>
4332 argument. Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a
4333 number are supported. The <fmt> field is interpreted as a log-format string
4334 so it may contain special expressions just like the <fmt> argument passed
4335 to "http-request set-uri". The match is exclusively case-sensitive. Any
4336 optional scheme, authority or query string are considered in the matching
4337 part of the URI. It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more
4338 expensive to evaluate than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit
4339 from a condition to avoid performing the evaluation at all if it does not
4340 match.
4341
4342 Example:
4343 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4344 http-request replace-uri (.*) /foo\1
4345
4346 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4347 http-request replace-uri ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4348
4349 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4350 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1
4351 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4352 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4353
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004354http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4355 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004357 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4358 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4359 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4360 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004361
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004362 Example:
4363 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004365 # applied to:
4366 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004367
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004368 # outputs:
4369 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004370
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004371http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4372http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004373
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004374 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4375 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4376 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004378http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004379
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004380 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4381 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4382 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004384http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004386 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4387 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4388 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4389 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4390 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004391
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004392 Arguments:
4393 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4394 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004395
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004396 Example:
4397 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4398 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004399
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004400 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4401 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004402
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004403http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004404
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004405 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4406 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4407 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004408
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004409 Arguments:
4410 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4411 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004412
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004413 Example:
4414 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4415 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004416
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004417 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4418 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4419 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004420
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004421http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004422
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004423 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4424 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4425 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4426 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4427 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004428
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004429 Example:
4430 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4431 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4432 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4433 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4434 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4435 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4436 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4437 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4438 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004439
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004440http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004441
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004442 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4443 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4444 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4445 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4446 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004447
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004448http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4449 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004450
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004451 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4452 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4453 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4454 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4455 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4456 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4457 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4458 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4459 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004460
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004461http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004462
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004463 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4464 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4465 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4466 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4467 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4468 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4469 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004470
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004471http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004472
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004473 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4474 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4475 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004476
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004477http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004478
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004479 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4480 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4481 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4482 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4483 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4484 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4485 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4486 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004487
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004488http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004489
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004490 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4491 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4492 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4493 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4494 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4495 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004496
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004497 Example :
4498 # prepend the host name before the path
4499 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004500
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004501http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004502
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004503 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4504 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4505 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4506 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4507 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004508
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004509http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004510
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004511 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4512 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4513 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4514 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4515 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4516 values have higher priority.
4517 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4518 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4519 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4520 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4521 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004522
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004523http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004524
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004525 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4526 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4527 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4528 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4529 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4530 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4531 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004532
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004533 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004534
4535 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004536 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4537 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004538
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004539http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4540 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4541 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4542 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4543 privacy.
4544
4545 Arguments :
4546 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4547 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004548
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004549 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004550 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4551 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4552
4553 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4554 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4555
4556http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4557
4558 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4559 expression.
4560
4561 Arguments:
4562 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4563 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004564
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004565 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004566 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4567 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4568
4569 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4570 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4571 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4572
4573http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4574
4575 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4576 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4577 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4578 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4579 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4580 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4581 information from the request.
4582
4583 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4584
4585http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4586
4587 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4588 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4589 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4590 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4591 path and the query string.
4592 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4593
4594http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4595
4596 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4597 inline.
4598
4599 Arguments:
4600 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4601 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4602 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4603 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4604 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4605 (request and response)
4606 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4607 processing
4608 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4609 processing
4610 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4611 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4612 and '_'.
4613
4614 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4615 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004616
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004617 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004618 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004620http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4621 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004622
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004623 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4624 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4625 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4626 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4627 agent name must be used.
4628
4629 Arguments:
4630 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4631
4632 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4633 configuration.
4634
4635http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4636
4637 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4638 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4639 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4640 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4641 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4642 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4643 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4644 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4645 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4646 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4647 action.
4648 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4649 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4650 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4651 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4652 you fully understand how it works.
4653
4654http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4655
4656 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4657 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4658 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4659 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4660 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4661 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4662 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4663 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4664 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4665 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4666 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4667 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4668 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4669
4670http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4671http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4672http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4673
4674 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4675 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4676 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4677 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4678 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4679 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4680 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4681 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4682 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4683 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4684 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4685 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4686
4687 Arguments :
4688 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4689 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4690 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4691 select which table entry to update the counters.
4692
4693 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4694 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4695 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4696 that table until the session ends.
4697
4698 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4699 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4700 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4701 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4702 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4703 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4704 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4705 useful information.
4706
4707 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4708 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4709 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4710 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4711 checks that make use of it.
4712
4713http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4714
4715 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004716
4717 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004718 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004719
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004720http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004721
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004722 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4723 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4724 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004725
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004726
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004727http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004728 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4729
4730 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4731 no | yes | yes | yes
4732
4733 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4734 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4735 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4736 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4737 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4738 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4739
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004740 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4741 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004742
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004743 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004744
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004745 Example:
4746 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004747
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004748 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004749
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004750 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4751 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004752
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004753 Example:
4754 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004755
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004756 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004757
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004758 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4759 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004760
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004761 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4762 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004763
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004764http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004765
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004766 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4767 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4768 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4769 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4770 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4771 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4772 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4773 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004774
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004775http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004776
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004777 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4778 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4779 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4780 example, or to pass some internal information.
4781 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4782 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4783 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004784
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004785http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004786
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004787 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4788 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004789
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004790http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004791
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004792 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004793
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004794http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004795
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004796 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4797 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4798 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4799 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4800 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4801 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4802 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004803
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004804 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4805 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4806 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4807 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4808 keyword.
4809 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4810 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004811
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004812http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004813
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004814 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4815 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4816 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4817 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4818 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4819 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004820
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004821http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004822
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004823 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004824
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004825http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004826
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004827 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4828 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4829 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4830 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4831 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4832 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004833
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004834http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004835
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004836 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4837 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004838
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004839http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004840
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004841 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4842 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4843 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4844 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4845 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4846 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004847
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004848http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4849 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004850
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004851 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4852 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4853 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4854 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4855 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4856 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4857 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4858 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004859
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004860 Example:
4861 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004862
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004863 # applied to:
4864 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004865
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004866 # outputs:
4867 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004868
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004869 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004870
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004871http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4872 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004873
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004874 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4875 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4876 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4877 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004878
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004879 Example:
4880 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004881
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004882 # applied to:
4883 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004884
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004885 # outputs:
4886 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004887
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004888http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4889http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004890
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004891 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4892 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4893 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004894
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004895http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004896
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004897 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4898 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4899 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004900
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004901http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004902
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004903 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4904 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4905 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4906 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4907 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004908
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004909 Arguments:
4910 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004911
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004912 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4913 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004914
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004915http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004916
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004917 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4918 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4919 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004920
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004921http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4922
4923 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4924 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4925 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4926 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4927 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4928
4929http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4930
4931 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4932 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4933 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4934 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4935 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4936 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4937 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4938 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4939 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4940
4941http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4942
4943 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4944 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4945 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4946 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
4947 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
4948 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
4949 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
4950
4951http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4952
4953 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4954 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4955 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4956 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4957 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
4958 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4959 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4960 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4961
4962http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4963 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4964
4965 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4966 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4967 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4968 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004969
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004970 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004971 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4972 http-response set-status 431
4973 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4974 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004975
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004976http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004977
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004978 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4979 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4980 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4981 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
4982 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
4983 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
4984 based on some information from the request.
4985
4986 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4987
4988http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4989
4990 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4991 inline.
4992
4993 Arguments:
4994 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4995 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4996 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4997 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4998 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4999 (request and response)
5000 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5001 processing
5002 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5003 processing
5004 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5005 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5006 and '_'.
5007
5008 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5009 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005010
5011 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005012 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005013
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005014http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005015
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005016 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5017 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5018 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5019 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5020 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5021 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5022 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5023 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5024 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5025 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5026 action.
5027 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5028 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5029 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5030 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5031 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005032
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005033http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5034http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5035http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005036
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005037 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5038 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5039 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5040 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5041 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5042 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5043
5044http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5045
5046 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5047 about <var-name>.
5048
5049 Example:
5050 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5051
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005052
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005053http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5054 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5055
5056 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5057 yes | no | yes | yes
5058
5059 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005060 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5061 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5062 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005063
5064 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5065
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005066 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5067 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5068 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5069 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5070 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5071 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5072 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5073 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5074 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5075 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005076
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005077 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5078 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5079 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5080 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5081 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5082 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5083 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5084 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005085
5086 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5087 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5088 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5089 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5090 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5091 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5092 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5093 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005094 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005095 downsides of rare connection failures.
5096
5097 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5098 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5099 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5100 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5101 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5102 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005103 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005104 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5105 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5106 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5107 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5108 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5109
5110 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005111 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5112 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5113 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005114
5115 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005116 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005117
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005118 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5119 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005120
5121 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5122 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5123 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5124
5125 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5126 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5127 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5128
5129 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5130
5131
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005132http-send-name-header [<header>]
5133 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5134
5135 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5136 yes | no | yes | yes
5137
5138 Arguments :
5139
5140 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5141
5142 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005143 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005144 is added with the header string proved.
5145
5146 See also : "server"
5147
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005148id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005149 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5151 no | yes | yes | yes
5152 Arguments : none
5153
5154 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5155 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5156 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005157
5158
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005159ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5160 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5161 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005162 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005163
5164 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5165 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5166 and running).
5167
5168 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5169 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5170 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005171 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005172 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5173
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005174 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5175 "unless" condition is met.
5176
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005177 Example:
5178 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5179 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5180 ignore-persist if url_static
5181
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005182 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5183
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005184load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5185 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5186 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5187 yes | no | yes | yes
5188
5189 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5190 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5191 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005192 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005193 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5194 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5195 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5196 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5197
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005198 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005199 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005200 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005201
5202 Arguments:
5203 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5204 named "server-state-file".
5205
5206 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5207 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5208 name is used as a file name.
5209
5210 none don't load any stat for this backend
5211
5212 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005213 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5214 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5215 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005216 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005217 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005218
5219 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5220 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5221
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005222 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005223
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005224 global
5225 stats socket /tmp/socket
5226 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005227
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005228 defaults
5229 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005230
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005231 backend bk
5232 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5233 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005234
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005235
5236 Then one can run :
5237
5238 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5239
5240 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5241
5242 1
5243 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5244 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5245 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5246
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005247 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005248
5249 global
5250 stats socket /tmp/socket
5251 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5252
5253 defaults
5254 load-server-state-from-file local
5255
5256 backend bk
5257 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5258 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5259
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005260
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005261 Then one can run :
5262
5263 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5264
5265 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5266
5267 1
5268 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5269 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5270 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5271
5272 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5273 "show servers state"
5274
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005275
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005276log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005277log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5278 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005279no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005280 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5282 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005283
5284 Prefix :
5285 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5286 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5287 prefix does not allow arguments.
5288
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005289 Arguments :
5290 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5291 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5292 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5293 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5294 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5295 parameter.
5296
5297 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5298 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5299
5300 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5301 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5302 standard syslog port).
5303
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005304 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5305 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5306 standard syslog port).
5307
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005308 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5309 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5310 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005311 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005312
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005313 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5314 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5315 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5316 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5317 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5318 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5319 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5320 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5321 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5322 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5323 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5324 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5325 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5326 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5327 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5328 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005329 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5330 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005331
5332 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5333 and "fd@2", see above.
5334
5335 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5336 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005337
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005338 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5339 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5340 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5341 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5342 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5343 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5344 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5345 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5346 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5347 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005348 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005349
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005350 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5351 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5352 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5353 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5354 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5355
5356 <sample_size>
5357 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5358 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5359 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5360 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5361 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5362
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005363 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5364 one of the following :
5365
5366 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5367 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5368
5369 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5370 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5371
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005372 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5373 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5374 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5375 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5376 systemd logger consumes.
5377
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005378 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5379 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5380 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5381 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5382
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005383 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5384
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005385 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5386 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5387 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5388
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005389 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5390 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5391 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5392 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005393
5394 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5395 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5396 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005397 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5398 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5399 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5400 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5401 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005402
5403 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5404
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005405 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5406 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5407 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005408
5409 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5410 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5411 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5412 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5413
5414 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5415 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005416
5417 Example :
5418 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005419 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5420 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5421 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005422 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5423 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005424 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005425
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005426
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005427log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005428 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5429 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5430 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005431
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005432 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5433 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5434 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5435 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5436 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005437
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005438 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5439 "option httplog" directives.
5440
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005441log-format-sd <string>
5442 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5443 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5444 yes | yes | yes | no
5445
5446 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5447 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5448 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5449 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5450 which covers the log format string in depth.
5451
5452 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5453 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5454
5455 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5456 log format to "rfc5424".
5457
5458 Example :
5459 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5460
5461
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005462log-tag <string>
5463 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5464 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5465 yes | yes | yes | yes
5466
5467 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5468 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5469 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5470 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5471 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5472 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5473 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5474 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5475 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005476
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005477max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5478 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5479 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5480 yes | no | yes | yes
5481
5482 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5483 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5484 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5485 servers.
5486
5487 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5488 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5489 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5490 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5491 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005492 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005493 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5494 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5495 picking a different server.
5496
5497 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5498 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5499 even if they have to be queued.
5500
5501 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5502 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5503
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005504max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5505 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5506 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5507 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005508
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005509maxconn <conns>
5510 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5512 yes | yes | yes | no
5513 Arguments :
5514 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5515 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5516 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5517 closes.
5518
5519 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5520 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5521 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5522 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005523 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5524 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5525 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5526 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005527
5528 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5529 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5530 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5531
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005532 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5533 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005534
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005535 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5536
5537
5538mode { tcp|http|health }
5539 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5541 yes | yes | yes | yes
5542 Arguments :
5543 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5544 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5545 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5546 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5547
5548 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5549 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5550 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5551 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5552 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5553
5554 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005555 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5556 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5557 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5558 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5559 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5560 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5561 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005562
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005563 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5564 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5565 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005566
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005567 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005568 defaults http_instances
5569 mode http
5570
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005571 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005572
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005573
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005574monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005575 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5577 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005578 Arguments :
5579 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5580 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005581 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005582 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5583 backend and its backup.
5584
5585 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5586 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5587 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5588 servers in a list of backends.
5589
5590 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5591 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5592 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5593 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5594 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5595 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5596 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005597 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5598 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005599
5600 Example:
5601 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005602 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005603 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5604 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5605 monitor-uri /site_alive
5606 monitor fail if site_dead
5607
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005608 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005609
5610
5611monitor-net <source>
5612 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5614 yes | yes | yes | no
5615 Arguments :
5616 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5617 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5618 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5619 followed by a mask.
5620
5621 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5622 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005623 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005624 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5625
5626 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5627 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5628 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5629 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005630 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5631 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5632 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005633
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005634 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5635 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5636 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5637 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5638 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5639 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005640
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005641 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5642 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005643
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005644 Example :
5645 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5646 frontend www
5647 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5648
5649 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5650
5651
5652monitor-uri <uri>
5653 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5655 yes | yes | yes | no
5656 Arguments :
5657 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5658 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5659
5660 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5661 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5662 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5663 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5664 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5665 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5666 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5667 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5668
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005669 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005670 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
5671 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5672 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5673 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5674 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5675 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005676
5677 Example :
5678 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5679 frontend www
5680 mode http
5681 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5682
5683 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5684
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005685
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005686option abortonclose
5687no option abortonclose
5688 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5690 yes | no | yes | yes
5691 Arguments : none
5692
5693 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5694 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5695 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5696 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005697 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005698 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5699 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5700 encountered while delivering the response.
5701
5702 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5703 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5704 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5705 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5706 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5707 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005708 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005709 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005710 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005711 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5712 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5713 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5714
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005715 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5716 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005717 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5718 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5719 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5720 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5721 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5722 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005723 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005724
5725 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5726 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5727
5728 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5729
5730
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005731option accept-invalid-http-request
5732no option accept-invalid-http-request
5733 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5735 yes | yes | yes | no
5736 Arguments : none
5737
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005738 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005739 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005740 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005741 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5742 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5743 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5744 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5745 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005746 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5747 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5748 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5749 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005750 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005751 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005752 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5753 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5754 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005755
5756 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5757 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5758 been confirmed.
5759
5760 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5761 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005762 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5763 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005764 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5765
5766 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5767 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5768
5769 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5770 stats socket.
5771
5772
5773option accept-invalid-http-response
5774no option accept-invalid-http-response
5775 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5777 yes | no | yes | yes
5778 Arguments : none
5779
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005780 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005781 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005782 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005783 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5784 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5785 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5786 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5787 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005788 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5789 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5790 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005791
5792 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5793 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5794 been confirmed.
5795
5796 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5797 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5798 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5799 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5800
5801 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5802 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5803
5804 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5805 stats socket.
5806
5807
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005808option allbackups
5809no option allbackups
5810 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5812 yes | no | yes | yes
5813 Arguments : none
5814
5815 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5816 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5817 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5818 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5819 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5820 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5821 order between the backup servers anymore.
5822
5823 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5824 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5825
5826 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5827 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5828
5829
5830option checkcache
5831no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005832 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5834 yes | no | yes | yes
5835 Arguments : none
5836
5837 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5838 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005839 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005840 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5841 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005842 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005843
5844 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005845 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005846 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005847 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5848 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005849 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005850 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005851 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5852 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005853 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005854 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5855 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005856 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005857 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5858 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5859 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5860 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5861 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5862 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5863 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5864 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5865 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5866
5867 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005868 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
5869 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
5870 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
5871 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005872
5873 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5874 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005875 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005876 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005877
5878 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5879 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5880
5881
5882option clitcpka
5883no option clitcpka
5884 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5886 yes | yes | yes | no
5887 Arguments : none
5888
5889 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5890 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005891 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005892 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5893
5894 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5895 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5896 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5897 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5898
5899 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5900 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5901 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5902 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5903 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5904
5905 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5906
5907 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5908 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5909 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5910
5911 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5912 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5913
5914 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5915
5916
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005917option contstats
5918 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5920 yes | yes | yes | no
5921 Arguments : none
5922
5923 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5924 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5925 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5926 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005927 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5928 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5929 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5930 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5931 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005932
5933
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005934option dontlog-normal
5935no option dontlog-normal
5936 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5938 yes | yes | yes | no
5939 Arguments : none
5940
5941 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5942 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5943 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5944 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5945 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5946 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5947 logged.
5948
5949 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5950 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5951 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5952
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005953 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005954 logging.
5955
5956
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005957option dontlognull
5958no option dontlognull
5959 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5961 yes | yes | yes | no
5962 Arguments : none
5963
5964 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5965 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5966 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5967 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5968 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5969 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005970 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5971 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5972 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005973
5974 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005975 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005976 would not be logged.
5977
5978 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5979 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5980
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005981 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5982 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005983
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005984
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005985option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005986 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5988 yes | yes | yes | yes
5989 Arguments :
5990 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5991 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005992 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005993 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005994
5995 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5996 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5997 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5998 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5999 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6000 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6001 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006002 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6003 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6004 possible that the client has already brought one.
6005
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006006 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006007 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006008 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006009 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006010 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006011 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006012
6013 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6014 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6015 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6016 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6017 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6018 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6019 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6020
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006021 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6022 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6023 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6024 are under the control of the end-user.
6025
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006026 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006027 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6028 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006029 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6030 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6031 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006032
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006033 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006034 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6035 frontend www
6036 mode http
6037 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6038
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006039 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6040 backend www
6041 mode http
6042 option forwardfor header X-Client
6043
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006044 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006045 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006046
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006047
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006048option http-buffer-request
6049no option http-buffer-request
6050 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6052 yes | yes | yes | yes
6053 Arguments : none
6054
6055 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6056 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6057 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6058 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6059 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6060 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6061 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6062 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006063 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006064 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6065 default.
6066
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006067 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006068
6069
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006070option http-ignore-probes
6071no option http-ignore-probes
6072 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6074 yes | yes | yes | no
6075 Arguments : none
6076
6077 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6078 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6079 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6080 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6081 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6082 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6083 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6084 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6085 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006086 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6087 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006088 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6089
6090 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6091 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6092 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6093 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6094 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6095 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6096 are often the only way to detect them.
6097
6098 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6099 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6100
6101 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6102
6103
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006104option http-keep-alive
6105no option http-keep-alive
6106 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6108 yes | yes | yes | yes
6109 Arguments : none
6110
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006111 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6112 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006113 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6114 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006115 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6116 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6117 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006118
6119 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6120 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006121 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6122 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6123 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6124 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6125 situations where this option may be useful :
6126
6127 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006128 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006129
6130 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6131 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6132
6133 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6134 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6135 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6136 request.
6137
6138 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6139 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006140 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6141 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6142 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006143
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006144 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6145 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6146 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6147 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6148 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6149 not set.
6150
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006151 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6152 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6153 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006154
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006155 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006156 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006157 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006158
6159
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006160option http-no-delay
6161no option http-no-delay
6162 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6164 yes | yes | yes | yes
6165 Arguments : none
6166
6167 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6168 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6169 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6170 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6171 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6172 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6173 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6174 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6175 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6176 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6177 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6178 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6179 affected.
6180
6181 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6182 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6183 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6184 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6185 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6186 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6187 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6188 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6189 latency environments.
6190
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006191 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6192
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006193
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006194option http-pretend-keepalive
6195no option http-pretend-keepalive
6196 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006198 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006199 Arguments : none
6200
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006201 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006202 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6203 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6204 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6205 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6206 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6207 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6208 consider the response complete.
6209
6210 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6211 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6212 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6213 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006214 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006215 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6216
6217 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6218 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6219 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6220 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6221 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6222 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6223 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6224
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006225 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6226 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6227 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6228 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6229 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6230 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006231
6232 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6233 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6234
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006235 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006236 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006237
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006238
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006239option http-server-close
6240no option http-server-close
6241 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6243 yes | yes | yes | yes
6244 Arguments : none
6245
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006246 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6247 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6248 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6249 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006250 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
6251 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
6252 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
6253 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
6254 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
6255 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
6256 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
6257 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
6258 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
6259 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
6260 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006261
6262 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6263 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6264 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6265 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006266 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6267 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006268
6269 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6270 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006271 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6272 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6273 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006274
6275 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6276 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6277
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006278 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6279 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006280
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006281option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006282no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006283 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6285 yes | yes | yes | no
6286 Arguments : none
6287
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006288 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006289 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6290 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6291 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6292 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6293 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6294 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6295
6296 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6297 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006298 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6299 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6300 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006301
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006302 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6303 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6304 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6305 front of an existing proxy.
6306
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006307 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6308
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006309 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006310
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006311option httpchk
6312option httpchk <uri>
6313option httpchk <method> <uri>
6314option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6315 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6317 yes | no | yes | yes
6318 Arguments :
6319 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6320 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6321 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6322 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6323 ones.
6324
6325 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6326 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6327 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6328
6329 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6330 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6331 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6332 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6333 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6334
6335 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6336 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6337 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6338 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6339 the lack of any response.
6340
6341 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6342
6343 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6344 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6345 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6346
6347 Examples :
6348 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6349 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6350 backend https_relay
6351 mode tcp
6352 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6353 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6354
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006355 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6356 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6357 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006358
6359
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006360option httpclose
6361no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006362 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6364 yes | yes | yes | yes
6365 Arguments : none
6366
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006367 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6368 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6369 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6370 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006371 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006372
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006373 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6374 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006375 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006376 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6377 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006378
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006379 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6380 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6381 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006382
6383 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6384 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006385 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
6386 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6387 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006388
6389 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6390 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6391
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006392 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006393
6394
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006395option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006396 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006398 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006399 Arguments :
6400 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6401 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6402 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006403 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006404 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006405
6406 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6407 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6408 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6409 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6410 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6411 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6412 ports.
6413
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006414 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6415 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006416
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006417 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006419 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006420
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006421
6422option http_proxy
6423no option http_proxy
6424 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6426 yes | yes | yes | yes
6427 Arguments : none
6428
6429 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6430 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6431 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6432 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6433 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6434
6435 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6436 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006437 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6438 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006439
6440 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6441 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6442
6443 Example :
6444 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6445 backend direct_forward
6446 option httpclose
6447 option http_proxy
6448
6449 See also : "option httpclose"
6450
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006451
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006452option independent-streams
6453no option independent-streams
6454 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6456 yes | yes | yes | yes
6457 Arguments : none
6458
6459 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6460 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6461 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6462 receive data or not.
6463
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006464 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006465 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6466 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6467 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6468 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6469 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6470 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6471 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6472 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6473 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6474 socket buffers.
6475
6476 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6477 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6478 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6479 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6480 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6481
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006482 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006483
6484
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006485option ldap-check
6486 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6488 yes | no | yes | yes
6489 Arguments : none
6490
6491 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6492 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6493 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6494 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6495
6496 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6497 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6498
6499 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6500 configure it.
6501
6502 Example :
6503 option ldap-check
6504
6505 See also : "option httpchk"
6506
6507
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006508option external-check
6509 Use external processes for server health checks
6510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6511 yes | no | yes | yes
6512
6513 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6514 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6515 command".
6516
6517 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6518
6519 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6520
6521
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006522option log-health-checks
6523no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006524 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6526 yes | no | yes | yes
6527 Arguments : none
6528
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006529 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6530 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6531 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006532
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006533 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6534 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6535 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6536 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6537 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6538
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006539 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006540 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006541
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006542 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6543 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6544 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006545
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006546
6547option log-separate-errors
6548no option log-separate-errors
6549 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6551 yes | yes | yes | no
6552 Arguments : none
6553
6554 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6555 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6556 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6557 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6558 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6559 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6560 provides very important information.
6561
6562 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6563 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6564 error logs.
6565
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006566 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006567 logging.
6568
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006569
6570option logasap
6571no option logasap
6572 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6574 yes | yes | yes | no
6575 Arguments : none
6576
6577 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6578 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6579 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6580 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6581 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6582 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6583 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006584 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006585 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6586 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6587
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006588 Examples :
6589 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6590 mode http
6591 option httplog
6592 option logasap
6593 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6594
6595 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6596 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6597 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6598 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6599
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006600 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006601 logging.
6602
6603
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006604option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006605 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6607 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006608 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006609 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6610 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006611 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006612
6613 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6614 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006615 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006616 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6617 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6618 in the MySQL table, like this :
6619
6620 USE mysql;
6621 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6622 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6623
6624 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006625 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006626 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6627 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6628 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6629 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6630 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6631 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6632 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6633
6634 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6635 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006636
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006637 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006638
6639 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6640 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6641 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6642 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006643 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6644 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006645
6646 See also: "option httpchk"
6647
6648
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006649option nolinger
6650no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006651 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006652 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6653 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006654 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006655
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006656 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006657 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6658 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6659 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6660 connections.
6661
6662 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6663 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6664 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6665 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6666 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6667 this too.
6668
6669 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6670 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6671 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6672
6673 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6674 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6675 for servers.
6676
6677 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6678 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6679
6680
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006681option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6682 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6684 yes | yes | yes | yes
6685 Arguments :
6686 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6687 matching <network>
6688 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6689 header name.
6690
6691 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6692 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6693 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6694 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6695 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6696 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6697 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6698 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6699 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6700 possible that the client has already brought one.
6701
6702 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6703 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6704 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6705 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6706 header and requires different one.
6707
6708 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6709 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6710 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6711 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6712 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6713 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6714 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6715
6716 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6717 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6718 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6719 both are defined.
6720
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006721 Examples :
6722 # Original Destination address
6723 frontend www
6724 mode http
6725 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6726
6727 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6728 backend www
6729 mode http
6730 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6731
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006732 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006733
6734
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006735option persist
6736no option persist
6737 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6738 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6739 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006740 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006741
6742 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6743 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6744 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6745 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6746 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6747 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6748 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6749 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6750 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6751 redirected to another valid server.
6752
6753 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6754 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6755
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006756 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006757
6758
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006759option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6760 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6762 yes | no | yes | yes
6763 Arguments :
6764 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6765 PostgreSQL server.
6766
6767 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6768 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6769 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6770 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6771
6772 See also: "option httpchk"
6773
6774
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006775option prefer-last-server
6776no option prefer-last-server
6777 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6778 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6779 yes | no | yes | yes
6780 Arguments : none
6781
6782 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6783 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6784 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6785 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6786 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6787 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6788 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6789 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6790 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006791 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6792 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006793 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6794 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6795 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006796 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6797 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6798 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006799
6800 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6801 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6802
6803 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6804
6805
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006806option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006807option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006808no option redispatch
6809 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6810 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6811 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006812 Arguments :
6813 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6814 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6815 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006816 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006817 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006818 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006819 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6820 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6821 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6822
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006823
6824 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6825 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6826 be able to access the service anymore.
6827
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006828 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6829 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006830
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006831 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006832 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6833 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006834
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006835 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6836 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6837
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006838 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006839
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006840
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006841option redis-check
6842 Use redis health checks for server testing
6843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6844 yes | no | yes | yes
6845 Arguments : none
6846
6847 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6848 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6849 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6850 find the "+PONG" response message.
6851
6852 Example :
6853 option redis-check
6854
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006855 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006856
6857
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006858option smtpchk
6859option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6860 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6862 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006863 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006864 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02006865 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006866 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6867
6868 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6869 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6870 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6871
6872 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6873 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6874 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6875 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6876 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6877 dead server.
6878
6879 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6880 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006881 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006882 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6883
6884 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6885 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6886 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6887 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006888 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006889
6890 Example :
6891 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6892
6893 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6894
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006895
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006896option socket-stats
6897no option socket-stats
6898
6899 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6901 yes | yes | yes | no
6902
6903 Arguments : none
6904
6905
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006906option splice-auto
6907no option splice-auto
6908 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6910 yes | yes | yes | yes
6911 Arguments : none
6912
6913 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6914 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006915 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006916 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006917 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006918 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6919 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6920 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6921 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6922
6923 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6924 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6925 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6926 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6927 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6928 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6929 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6930 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6931 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6932 keyword.
6933
6934 Example :
6935 option splice-auto
6936
6937 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6938 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6939
6940 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6941 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6942
6943
6944option splice-request
6945no option splice-request
6946 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6948 yes | yes | yes | yes
6949 Arguments : none
6950
6951 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006952 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006953 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6954 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6955 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6956 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6957
6958 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6959
6960 Example :
6961 option splice-request
6962
6963 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6964 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6965
6966 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6967 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6968
6969
6970option splice-response
6971no option splice-response
6972 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6974 yes | yes | yes | yes
6975 Arguments : none
6976
6977 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006978 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006979 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6980 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6981 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6982 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6983
6984 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6985
6986 Example :
6987 option splice-response
6988
6989 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6990 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6991
6992 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6993 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6994
6995
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006996option spop-check
6997 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6999 no | no | no | yes
7000 Arguments : none
7001
7002 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7003 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7004 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7005 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7006
7007 Example :
7008 option spop-check
7009
7010 See also : "option httpchk"
7011
7012
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007013option srvtcpka
7014no option srvtcpka
7015 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7017 yes | no | yes | yes
7018 Arguments : none
7019
7020 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7021 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007022 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007023 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7024
7025 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7026 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7027 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7028 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7029
7030 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7031 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7032 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7033 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7034 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7035
7036 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7037
7038 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7039 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7040 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7041
7042 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7043 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7044
7045 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7046
7047
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007048option ssl-hello-chk
7049 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7051 yes | no | yes | yes
7052 Arguments : none
7053
7054 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7055 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7056 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7057 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7058 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7059 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7060 hello message.
7061
7062 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7063 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7064 messages, which is appreciable.
7065
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007066 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7067 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7068 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007069
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007070 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7071
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007072
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007073option tcp-check
7074 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7075 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7076 yes | no | yes | yes
7077
7078 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7079 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7080
7081 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7082 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7083 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7084
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007085 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007086 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7087 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7088 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7089 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7090 only.
7091
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007092 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007093 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7094 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7095 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7096 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7097
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007098 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007099 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7100 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007101 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007102 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7103 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7104 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7105 the respective protocols.
7106 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007107 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007108
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007109 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7110 script.
7111
7112 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7113 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7114 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7115 The "comment" is of course optional.
7116
7117
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007118 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007119 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007120 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007121 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007122
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007123 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007124 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007125 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007126
7127 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7128 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007129 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007130 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007131 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007132 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007133 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007134 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007135 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7136 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007137 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007138 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7139 tcp-check expect string +OK
7140
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007141 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007142 (send many headers before analyzing)
7143 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007144 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007145 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7146 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7147 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7148 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007149 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007150
7151
7152 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7153
7154
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007155option tcp-smart-accept
7156no option tcp-smart-accept
7157 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7159 yes | yes | yes | no
7160 Arguments : none
7161
7162 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7163 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7164 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7165 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7166 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7167 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7168
7169 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7170 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7171 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7172 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7173
7174 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7175 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7176 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007177 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007178
7179 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7180 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7181 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7182
7183 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7184 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7185 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7186
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007187 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7188
7189
7190option tcp-smart-connect
7191no option tcp-smart-connect
7192 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7194 yes | no | yes | yes
7195 Arguments : none
7196
7197 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7198 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7199 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7200 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7201 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7202
7203 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7204 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7205 complex.
7206
7207 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7208 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7209 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7210
7211 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7212 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7213
7214 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7215
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007216
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007217option tcpka
7218 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7220 yes | yes | yes | yes
7221 Arguments : none
7222
7223 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7224 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007225 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007226 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7227
7228 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7229 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7230 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7231 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7232
7233 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7234 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7235 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7236 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7237 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7238
7239 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7240
7241 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7242 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7243 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7244 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7245 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7246 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7247 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7248 backends.
7249
7250 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7251
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007252
7253option tcplog
7254 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007256 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007257 Arguments : none
7258
7259 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7260 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7261 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7262 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7263 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7264 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7265 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7266 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7267
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007268 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007270 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007271
7272
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007273option transparent
7274no option transparent
7275 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007277 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007278 Arguments : none
7279
7280 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7281 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7282 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7283 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7284 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7285 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7286 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7287 appropriate server.
7288
7289 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7290 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7291
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007292 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007293 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007294
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007295
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007296external-check command <command>
7297 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7299 yes | no | yes | yes
7300
7301 Arguments :
7302 <command> is the external command to run
7303
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007304 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7305
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007306 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007307
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007308 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7309 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7310 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7311 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7312 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7313 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007314
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007315 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7316
7317 Environment variables :
7318 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7319 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7320
7321 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7322
7323 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7324
7325 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7326 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7327 for a UNIX socket).
7328
7329 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7330
7331 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7332
7333 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7334
7335 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7336
7337 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7338
7339 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7340 socket).
7341
7342 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7343 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7344
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007345 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7346
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007347 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7348 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7349 failed.
7350
7351 Example :
7352 external-check command /bin/true
7353
7354 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7355
7356
7357external-check path <path>
7358 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7360 yes | no | yes | yes
7361
7362 Arguments :
7363 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7364
7365 The default path is "".
7366
7367 Example :
7368 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7369
7370 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7371 "external-check command"
7372
7373
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007374persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007375persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007376 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7378 yes | no | yes | yes
7379 Arguments :
7380 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007381 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7382 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007383
7384 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7385 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007386 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007387 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7388 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7389 forwarded to this server.
7390
7391 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7392 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7393 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007394 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007395 a single "listen" section.
7396
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007397 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7398 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7399 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7400
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007401 Example :
7402 listen tse-farm
7403 bind :3389
7404 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7405 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7406 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7407 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7408 persist rdp-cookie
7409 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007410 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007411 balance rdp-cookie
7412 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7413 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7414
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007415 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7416 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007417
7418
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007419rate-limit sessions <rate>
7420 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7422 yes | yes | yes | no
7423 Arguments :
7424 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7425 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7426
7427 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7428 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7429 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7430 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7431 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7432 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7433
7434 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7435 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7436 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7437 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7438
7439 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7440 listen smtp
7441 mode tcp
7442 bind :25
7443 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007444 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007445
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007446 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7447 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7448 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007449
7450 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7451
7452
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007453redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7454redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7455redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007456 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7458 no | yes | yes | yes
7459
7460 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007461 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007462
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007463 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007464 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007465 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7466 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7467 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007468
7469 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7470 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7471 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7472 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7473 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007474 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7475 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7476 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7477 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007478
7479 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7480 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7481 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7482 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7483 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7484 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007485 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007486 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007487 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7488 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7489 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007490
7491 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007492 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7493 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7494 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007495 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007496 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7497 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7498 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7499 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007500
7501 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007502 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007503
7504 - "drop-query"
7505 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7506 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7507 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7508 with a location-type redirect.
7509
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007510 - "append-slash"
7511 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7512 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7513 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7514 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7515
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007516 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7517 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7518 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7519 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7520 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7521 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7522 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7523
7524 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7525 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7526 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7527 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7528 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7529 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7530 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007531
7532 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7533 acl clear dst_port 80
7534 acl secure dst_port 8080
7535 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007536 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007537 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007538 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7539
7540 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007541 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7542 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7543 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007544 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007545
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007546 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7547 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7548 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7549
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007550 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007551 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007552
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007553 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007554 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7555 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7556 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007557
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007558 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007559
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007560
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007561retries <value>
7562 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7563 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7564 yes | no | yes | yes
7565 Arguments :
7566 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7567 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7568 default value is 3.
7569
7570 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7571 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7572 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7573
7574 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007575 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7576 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007577
7578 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7579 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7580
7581 See also : "option redispatch"
7582
7583
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007584retry-on [list of keywords]
7585 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
7586 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7587 yes | no | yes | yes
7588 Arguments :
7589 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
7590 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
7591 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
7592 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
7593
7594 none never retry
7595
7596 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
7597 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
7598
7599 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
7600 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
7601 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
7602 request timeout on the server side, poor network
7603 condition, or a server crash or restart while
7604 processing the request.
7605
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02007606 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
7607 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
7608 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
7609 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
7610 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
7611 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
7612 overflow attack for example).
7613
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007614 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
7615 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
7616 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
7617 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
7618 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
7619 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
7620 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
7621 amplify denial of service attacks.
7622
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02007623 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
7624 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
7625 considered to be safe to retry.
7626
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007627 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
7628 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
7629 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
7630 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
7631
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02007632 all-retryable-errors
7633 retry request for any error that are considered
7634 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
7635 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
7636 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
7637
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007638 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
7639 not cumulative.
7640
7641 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
7642 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
7643 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
7644 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
7645
7646 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
7647 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
7648 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
7649 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
7650 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
7651 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
7652 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
7653 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
7654 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
7655 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
7656 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
7657 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
7658
7659 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
7660 should not use this directive.
7661
7662 The default is "conn-failure".
7663
7664 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
7665
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007666server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007667 Declare a server in a backend
7668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7669 no | no | yes | yes
7670 Arguments :
7671 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007672 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007673 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007674
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007675 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7676 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7677 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7678 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007679 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7680 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7681 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7682 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7683 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007684 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7685 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7686 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7687 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7688 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7689 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7690 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007691 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02007692 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
7693 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
7694 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
7695 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
7696 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
7697 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007698 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7699 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007700 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7701 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007702
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007703 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007704 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7705 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7706 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7707 adding this value to the client's port.
7708
7709 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7710 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007711 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007712
7713 Examples :
7714 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7715 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007716 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007717 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7718 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7719 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007720
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007721 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7722 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7723 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7724 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7725 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7726
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007727 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7728 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007729
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007730server-state-file-name [<file>]
7731 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7732 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7733 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7734 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7735 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7736 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7737
7738 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7739 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7740
7741 global
7742 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7743
7744 backend bk
7745 load-server-state-from-file
7746
7747 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7748 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007749
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007750server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7751 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7752 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7754 no | no | yes | yes
7755
7756 Arguments:
7757 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7758
7759 <num | range>
7760 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7761 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7762 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7763 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7764
7765 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7766
7767 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7768
7769 <params*>
7770 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7771 keyword.
7772
7773 Examples:
7774 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7775 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7776 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7777
7778 # or
7779 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7780
7781 # would be equivalent to:
7782 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7783 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7784 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7785
7786
7787
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007788source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007789source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007790source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007791 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7793 yes | no | yes | yes
7794 Arguments :
7795 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7796 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007797
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007798 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007799 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7800 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7801 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7802 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7803 supported prefixes are :
7804 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7805 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7806 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007807 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007808 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7809 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007810
7811 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7812 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007813 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7814 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7815 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007816
7817 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7818 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7819 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7820 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7821 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7822 <addr>.
7823
7824 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7825 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7826 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7827 port.
7828
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007829 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7830 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7831 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7832 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007833 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007834 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7835 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7836 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7837 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7838 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7839 HTTP header.
7840
7841 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7842 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007843 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007844 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7845 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7846 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7847 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7848 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7849 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7850 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7851
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007852 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7853 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7854 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7855 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7856 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7857 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7858
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007859 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7860 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7861 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7862 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7863
7864 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7865 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7866 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7867 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7868 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7869 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7870
7871 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7872 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7873 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7874 there are two methods :
7875
7876 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7877 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7878 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7879 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7880 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7881 of the client ranges may be used.
7882
7883 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7884 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7885 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7886 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7887 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7888 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7889 same session.
7890
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007891 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7892 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7893 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007894 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007895
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007896 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7897
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007898 Examples :
7899 backend private
7900 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7901 source 192.168.1.200
7902
7903 backend transparent_ssl1
7904 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7905 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7906
7907 backend transparent_ssl2
7908 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7909 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7910 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7911
7912 backend transparent_ssl3
7913 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7914 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7915 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7916
7917 backend transparent_smtp
7918 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7919 # with Tproxy version 4.
7920 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7921
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007922 backend transparent_http
7923 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7924 # proxy.
7925 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007927 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007928 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7929
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007930
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007931stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7932 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007934 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007935
7936 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7937 matched.
7938
7939 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7940 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7941
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007942 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7943 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007944 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007945
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007946 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7947 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7948 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7949 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007950
7951 Example :
7952 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7953 backend stats_localhost
7954 stats enable
7955 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7956
7957 Example :
7958 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7959 backend stats_auth
7960 stats enable
7961 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7962 stats admin if TRUE
7963
7964 Example :
7965 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7966 userlist stats-auth
7967 group admin users admin
7968 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7969 group readonly users haproxy
7970 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7971
7972 backend stats_auth
7973 stats enable
7974 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7975 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7976 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7977 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7978
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007979 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7980 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7981 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007982
7983
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007984stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7985 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007987 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007988 Arguments :
7989 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7990
7991 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7992
7993 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7994 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7995 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7996 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7997 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7998 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7999
8000 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8001 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8002 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008003 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008004
8005 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8006 report using "stats scope".
8007
8008 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8009 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8010 unobvious parameters.
8011
8012 Example :
8013 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8014 backend public_www
8015 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8016 stats enable
8017 stats hide-version
8018 stats scope .
8019 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008020 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008021 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8022 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8023
8024 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8025 backend private_monitoring
8026 stats enable
8027 stats uri /admin?stats
8028 stats refresh 5s
8029
8030 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8031
8032
8033stats enable
8034 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008036 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008037 Arguments : none
8038
8039 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8040 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8041 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8042 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8043 - stats auth : no authentication
8044 - stats scope : no restriction
8045
8046 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8047 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8048 unobvious parameters.
8049
8050 Example :
8051 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8052 backend public_www
8053 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8054 stats enable
8055 stats hide-version
8056 stats scope .
8057 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008058 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008059 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8060 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8061
8062 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8063 backend private_monitoring
8064 stats enable
8065 stats uri /admin?stats
8066 stats refresh 5s
8067
8068 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8069
8070
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008071stats hide-version
8072 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008074 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008075 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008076
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008077 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8078 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8079 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8080 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8081 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8082 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008083
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008084 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8085 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8086 unobvious parameters.
8087
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008088 Example :
8089 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8090 backend public_www
8091 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008092 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008093 stats hide-version
8094 stats scope .
8095 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008096 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008097 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8098 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008099
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008100 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8101 backend private_monitoring
8102 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008103 stats uri /admin?stats
8104 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008105
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008106 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008107
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008108
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008109stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8110 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8111 Access control for statistics
8112
8113 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8114 no | no | yes | yes
8115
8116 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8117 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8118 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8119 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8120 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8121 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8122
8123 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8124 instance.
8125
8126 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8127 about ACL usage.
8128
8129
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008130stats realm <realm>
8131 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008133 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008134 Arguments :
8135 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8136 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8137 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8138
8139 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8140 using a backslash ('\').
8141
8142 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8143 only related to authentication.
8144
8145 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8146 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8147 unobvious parameters.
8148
8149 Example :
8150 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8151 backend public_www
8152 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8153 stats enable
8154 stats hide-version
8155 stats scope .
8156 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008157 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008158 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8159 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8160
8161 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8162 backend private_monitoring
8163 stats enable
8164 stats uri /admin?stats
8165 stats refresh 5s
8166
8167 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8168
8169
8170stats refresh <delay>
8171 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008173 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008174 Arguments :
8175 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8176 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8177 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8178 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8179 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8180 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8181
8182 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8183 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8184 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8185 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8186
8187 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8188 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8189 unobvious parameters.
8190
8191 Example :
8192 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8193 backend public_www
8194 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8195 stats enable
8196 stats hide-version
8197 stats scope .
8198 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008199 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008200 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8201 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8202
8203 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8204 backend private_monitoring
8205 stats enable
8206 stats uri /admin?stats
8207 stats refresh 5s
8208
8209 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8210
8211
8212stats scope { <name> | "." }
8213 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008215 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008216 Arguments :
8217 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8218 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8219 section in which the statement appears.
8220
8221 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8222 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8223 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8224 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8225 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8226 exists.
8227
8228 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8229 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8230 unobvious parameters.
8231
8232 Example :
8233 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8234 backend public_www
8235 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8236 stats enable
8237 stats hide-version
8238 stats scope .
8239 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008240 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008241 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8242 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8243
8244 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8245 backend private_monitoring
8246 stats enable
8247 stats uri /admin?stats
8248 stats refresh 5s
8249
8250 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8251
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008252
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008253stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008254 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008256 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008257
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008258 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008259 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8260
8261 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8262 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8263
8264 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8265 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008266 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008267
8268 Example :
8269 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8270 backend private_monitoring
8271 stats enable
8272 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8273 stats uri /admin?stats
8274 stats refresh 5s
8275
8276 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8277 global section.
8278
8279
8280stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008281 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8283 yes | yes | yes | yes
8284 Arguments : none
8285
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008286 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008287 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8288 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8289 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8290 - IP (socket, server)
8291 - cookie (backend, server)
8292
8293 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8294 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008295 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008296
8297 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8298
8299
8300stats show-node [ <name> ]
8301 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008303 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008304 Arguments:
8305 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8306 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8307
8308 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8309 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008310 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008311
8312 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8313 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8314 unobvious parameters.
8315
8316 Example:
8317 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8318 backend private_monitoring
8319 stats enable
8320 stats show-node Europe-1
8321 stats uri /admin?stats
8322 stats refresh 5s
8323
8324 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8325 section.
8326
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008327
8328stats uri <prefix>
8329 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008331 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008332 Arguments :
8333 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8334 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8335 query string.
8336
8337 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8338 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8339 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8340 possible to reach it in the application.
8341
8342 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008343 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008344 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8345 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8346 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8347 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8348
8349 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8350 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8351 an address or a port to statistics only.
8352
8353 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8354 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8355 unobvious parameters.
8356
8357 Example :
8358 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8359 backend public_www
8360 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8361 stats enable
8362 stats hide-version
8363 stats scope .
8364 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008365 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008366 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8367 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8368
8369 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8370 backend private_monitoring
8371 stats enable
8372 stats uri /admin?stats
8373 stats refresh 5s
8374
8375 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8376
8377
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008378stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8379 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008381 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008382
8383 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008384 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008385 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008386 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008387 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8388
8389 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8390 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8391 the "stick-table" statement.
8392
8393 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8394 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8395 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8396 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8397 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8398
8399 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8400 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8401 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8402 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8403 transformation rules.
8404
8405 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8406 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8407 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8408 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8409 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8410 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8411 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8412
8413 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8414 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8415 ACL based conditions.
8416
8417 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8418 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8419 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8420 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8421
8422 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8423 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8424 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8425 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8426
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008427 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8428 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008429 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008430
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008431 Example :
8432 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8433 # last 30 minutes
8434 backend pop
8435 mode tcp
8436 balance roundrobin
8437 stick store-request src
8438 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8439 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8440 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8441
8442 backend smtp
8443 mode tcp
8444 balance roundrobin
8445 stick match src table pop
8446 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8447 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8448
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008449 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008450 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008451
8452
8453stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8454 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8456 no | no | yes | yes
8457
8458 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8459 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8460 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8461 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8462
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008463 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8464 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008465 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008466
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008467 Examples :
8468 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008469 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008470
8471 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8472 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8473 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8474
8475
8476 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8477 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8478 backend http
8479 mode http
8480 balance roundrobin
8481 stick on src table https
8482 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8483 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8484 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8485
8486 backend https
8487 mode tcp
8488 balance roundrobin
8489 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8490 stick on src
8491 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8492 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8493
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008494 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008495
8496
8497stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8498 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8500 no | no | yes | yes
8501
8502 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008503 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008504 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008505 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008506 server is selected.
8507
8508 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8509 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8510 the "stick-table" statement.
8511
8512 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8513 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8514 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8515 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8516 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8517 address.
8518
8519 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8520 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8521 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8522 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8523 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8524 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8525 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8526 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8527 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8528 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8529
8530 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8531 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8532 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8533 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8534 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8535 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8536 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8537
8538 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8539 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8540 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8541 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8542
8543 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8544 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8545 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8546 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8547 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8548 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008549 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8550 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8551 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8552 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8553 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8554 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008555
8556 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8557 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8558 the request.
8559
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008560 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8561 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008562 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008563
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008564 Example :
8565 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8566 # last 30 minutes
8567 backend pop
8568 mode tcp
8569 balance roundrobin
8570 stick store-request src
8571 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8572 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8573 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8574
8575 backend smtp
8576 mode tcp
8577 balance roundrobin
8578 stick match src table pop
8579 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8580 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8581
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008582 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008583 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008584
8585
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008586stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008587 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8588 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008589 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008591 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008592
8593 Arguments :
8594 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8595 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8596 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8597 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8598
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008599 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8600 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8601 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8602 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8603
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008604 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8605 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8606 instance.
8607
8608 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8609 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8610 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8611 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8612 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8613 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008614 to 32 characters.
8615
8616 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8617 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8618 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008619 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008620 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8621 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008622
8623 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008624 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8625 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008626 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8627 increase.
8628
8629 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008630 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8631 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8632 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008633
8634 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8635 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8636 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8637 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008638 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008639 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8640 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8641 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8642 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8643 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8644 parameter (see below).
8645
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008646 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8647 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8648 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8649 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8650 soft restart.
8651
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008652 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8653 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008654
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008655 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8656 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8657 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8658 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008659 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008660 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008661 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8662 if not expiration delay is specified.
8663
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008664 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8665 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8666 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8667 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008668 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8669 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8670 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8671 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8672 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8673 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8674 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8675 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8676 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8677 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8678 types and their arguments.
8679
8680 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8681 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8682 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8683 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8684
8685 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8686 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8687 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008688 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008689
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008690 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8691 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8692 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008693 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008694 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008695 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008696
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008697 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8698 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8699 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8700 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
8701
8702 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
8703 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8704 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8705 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8706 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8707 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
8708
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008709 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8710 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8711 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8712 they were received.
8713
8714 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8715 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8716 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8717 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8718 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8719
8720 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8721 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8722 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8723 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8724 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8725
8726 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8727 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8728 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8729
8730 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8731 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8732 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8733 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8734 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8735
8736 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8737 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8738 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8739 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8740 the client side.
8741
8742 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8743 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8744 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8745 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8746 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8747 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8748 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8749
8750 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8751 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8752 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8753 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8754 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8755 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008756 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008757
8758 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8759 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8760 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8761 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8762 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8763 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8764
8765 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008766 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008767 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8768 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8769
8770 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8771 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8772 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8773 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8774 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8775 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8776 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8777 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8778 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8779 recommended for better fairness.
8780
8781 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008782 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008783 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8784 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8785
8786 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8787 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8788 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8789 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8790 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8791 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8792 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8793 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8794 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8795 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008796
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008797 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8798 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008799 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8800 reference it.
8801
8802 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8803 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008804 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8805 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8806 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008807
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008808 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8809 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8810 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8811 something that can be ignored.
8812
8813 Example:
8814 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8815 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8816 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8817 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8818
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008819 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008820 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008821
8822
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008823stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008824 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8826 no | no | yes | yes
8827
8828 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008829 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008830 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008831 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008832 server is selected.
8833
8834 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8835 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8836 the "stick-table" statement.
8837
8838 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8839 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8840 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8841 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8842
8843 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8844 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8845 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8846 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8847 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8848 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008849 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008850 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8851 rules.
8852
8853 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8854 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8855 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8856 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8857 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8858 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8859 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8860
8861 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8862 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8863 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8864 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8865
8866 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8867 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8868 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8869 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8870 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8871 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008872 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8873 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8874 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8875 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8876 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8877 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8878 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8879 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8880 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008881
8882 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8883
8884 Example :
8885 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8886 backend https
8887 mode tcp
8888 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008889 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008890 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008891
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008892 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8893 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8894
8895 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8896 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8897 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8898
8899 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8900 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008901
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008902 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8903 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8904 # at offset 44.
8905
8906 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8907 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8908
8909 # Learn on response if server hello.
8910 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008911
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008912 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8913 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8914
8915 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8916 extraction.
8917
8918
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008919tcp-check connect [params*]
8920 Opens a new connection
8921 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8922 no | no | yes | yes
8923
8924 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8925 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8926 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8927
8928 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8929 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8930 of the sequence.
8931
8932 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8933 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8934 do.
8935
8936 Parameters :
8937 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8938 use the TCP connection.
8939
8940 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8941 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8942 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8943
8944 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8945
8946 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8947
8948 Examples:
8949 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8950 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8951 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8952 option tcp-check
8953 tcp-check connect
8954 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8955 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8956 tcp-check send \r\n
8957 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8958 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8959 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8960 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8961 tcp-check send \r\n
8962 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8963 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8964
8965 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8966 option tcp-check
8967 tcp-check connect port 110
8968 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8969 tcp-check connect port 143
8970 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8971 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8972
8973 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8974
8975
8976tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008977 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008978 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8979 no | no | yes | yes
8980
8981 Arguments :
8982 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8983 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8984 binary.
8985 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8986 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8987 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8988
8989 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8990 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8991 with the usual backslash ('\').
8992 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008993 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008994 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8995 used upper or lower case.
8996
8997
8998 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8999
9000 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9001 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9002 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9003 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9004 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9005 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9006 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9007 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9008
9009 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9010 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9011 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9012 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9013 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9014 expression.
9015
9016 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9017 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9018 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9019 this exact hexadecimal string.
9020 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9021
9022 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9023 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9024 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9025 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9026 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9027 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9028 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9029 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9030 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9031 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9032 the null character.
9033
9034 Examples :
9035 # perform a POP check
9036 option tcp-check
9037 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9038
9039 # perform an IMAP check
9040 option tcp-check
9041 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9042
9043 # look for the redis master server
9044 option tcp-check
9045 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009046 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009047 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9048 tcp-check expect string role:master
9049 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9050 tcp-check expect string +OK
9051
9052
9053 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9054 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9055
9056
9057tcp-check send <data>
9058 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9059 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9060 no | no | yes | yes
9061
9062 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9063 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9064
9065 Examples :
9066 # look for the redis master server
9067 option tcp-check
9068 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9069 tcp-check expect string role:master
9070
9071 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9072 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9073
9074
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009075tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9076 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009077 tcp health check
9078 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9079 no | no | yes | yes
9080
9081 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9082 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009083 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009084 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9085 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9086 hexadecimal string.
9087 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9088
9089 Examples :
9090 # redis check in binary
9091 option tcp-check
9092 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9093 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9094
9095
9096 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9097 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9098
9099
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009100tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9101 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9103 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009104 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009105 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9106 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009107
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009108 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009109
9110 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9111 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009112 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9113 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9114 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9115 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9116 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9117 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009118
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009119 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9120 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9121 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9122 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009123
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009124 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009125 - accept :
9126 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9127 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9128 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009129
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009130 - reject :
9131 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9132 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9133 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9134 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9135 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9136 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9137 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9138 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9139 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9140 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9141 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009142 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009143
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009144 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9145 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9146 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9147 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9148 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9149 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9150 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9151 hosts.
9152
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009153 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9154 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9155 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9156 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9157 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9158 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9159 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9160 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9161
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009162 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9163 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9164 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9165 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9166 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9167 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9168 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9169 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9170 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009171 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9172 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009173
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009174 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009175 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009176 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9177 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9178 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009179 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009180 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9181 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9182 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9183 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9184 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9185 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9186 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9187 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009188
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009189 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009190 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009191 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009192 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009193 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9194 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9195 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009196
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009197 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9198 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9199 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9200 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009201
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009202 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9203 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9204 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9205 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9206 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009207 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9208 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9209 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9210 layer7 information is extracted.
9211
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009212 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9213 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9214 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9215 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9216 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009217
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009218 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9219 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9220 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9221 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9222
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009223 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9224 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9225 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9226 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9227
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009228 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9229 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9230 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9231 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9232 continues.
9233
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009234 - set-src <expr> :
9235 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9236 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9237 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009238 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009239
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009240 Arguments:
9241 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9242 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009243
9244 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009245 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9246
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009247 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9248 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009249
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009250 - set-src-port <expr> :
9251 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9252 expression.
9253
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009254 Arguments:
9255 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9256 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009257
9258 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009259 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9260
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009261 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9262 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9263 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009264
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009265 - set-dst <expr> :
9266 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9267 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9268 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9269 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9270 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9271
9272 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9273 followed by some converters.
9274
9275 Example:
9276
9277 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9278 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9279
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009280 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9281 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9282
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009283 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9284 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9285 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9286 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9287
9288
9289 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9290 followed by some converters.
9291
9292 Example:
9293
9294 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9295
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009296 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9297 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9298 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9299
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009300 - "silent-drop" :
9301 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009302 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009303 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9304 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9305 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9306 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9307 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009308 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9309 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009310 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9311 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009312 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009313 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9314 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9315 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9316 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9317
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009318 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9319 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9320 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009321
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009322 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9323 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9324 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009325
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009326 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009327 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009328 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009329
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009330 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9331 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9332 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009333
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009334 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009335 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9336 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009337
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009338 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9339
9340 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9341
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009342 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9343
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009344 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009345
9346
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009347tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9348 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009350 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009351 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009352 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9353 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009354
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009355 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009356
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009357 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009358 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9359 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9360 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9361 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009362
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009363 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9364 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9365 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9366 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009367 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9368 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9369 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9370 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9371 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9372 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009373 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009374 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009375
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009376 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9377 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9378 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9379 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009380
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009381 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009382 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009383 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009384 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9385 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009386 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009387 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009388 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009389 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009390 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009391 - set-dst <expr>
9392 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009393 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009394 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009395 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009396 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009397
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009398 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9399 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009400 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9401 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009402
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009403 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9404 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9405 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9406 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9407 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9408 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009409
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009410 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009411 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9412 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009413
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009414 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009415 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9416 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9417 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9418 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009419 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9420 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9421 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009422
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009423 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009424 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9425 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9426 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009427
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009428 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
9429 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
9430
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009431 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009432 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9433 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009434
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009435 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9436 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009437 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009438 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9439 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009440 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009441 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009442 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009443 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9444 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009445 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009446 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9447 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009448
9449 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9450 followed by some converters.
9451
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009452 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9453 <var-name>.
9454
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009455 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9456 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9457 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9458 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9459 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9460
9461 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9462 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9463 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9464 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9465 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9466 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9467 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9468 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9469 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9470 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9471 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9472
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009473 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9474 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9475 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9476 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9477 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9478
9479 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9480
9481 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9482
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009483 Example:
9484
9485 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009486 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009487
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009488 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009489 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9490 # and reject everything else.
9491 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9492 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009493 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009494 tcp-request content reject
9495
9496 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009497 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9498 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9499 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009500 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009501
9502 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9503 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9504 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009505 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009506 tcp-request content reject
9507
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009508 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009509 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009510 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009511 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009512 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9513 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009514
9515 Example:
9516 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9517 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009518 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009519
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009520 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009521 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009522
9523 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009524 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009525 # protecting all our sites
9526 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009527 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9528 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009529 ...
9530 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9531
9532 backend http_dynamic
9533 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009534 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009535 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009536 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009537 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009538 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009539 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009540
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009541 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009542
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009543 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9544 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009545
9546
9547tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9548 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009550 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009551 Arguments :
9552 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9553 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9554 as explained at the top of this document.
9555
9556 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9557 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9558 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9559 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9560 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9561
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009562 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9563 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9564 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9565 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9566
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009567 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9568 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009569 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009570 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009571 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9572 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9573 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9574 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009575
9576 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9577 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9578 it pass through unaffected.
9579
9580 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9581 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9582 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009583 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009584 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9585 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009586 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9587 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9588 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009589
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009590 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009591 "timeout client".
9592
9593
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009594tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9595 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9597 no | no | yes | yes
9598 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009599 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9600 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009601
9602 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9603
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009604 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009605 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9606 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009607 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9608 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009609
9610 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9611
9612 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9613 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9614 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9615 inserted.
9616
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009617 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009618 - accept :
9619 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9620 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9621 the rules evaluation.
9622
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009623 - close :
9624 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9625 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9626 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9627 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9628 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9629 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009630 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009631 protocols.
9632
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009633 - reject :
9634 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9635 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009636 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009637
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009638 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9639 Sets a variable.
9640
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009641 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9642 Unsets a variable.
9643
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009644 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9645 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9646 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9647 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9648
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009649 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9650 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9651 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9652 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9653
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009654 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9655 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9656 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9657 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9658 continues.
9659
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009660 - "silent-drop" :
9661 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009662 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009663 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9664 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9665 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9666 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9667 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009668 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9669 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009670 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9671 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009672 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009673 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9674 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9675 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9676 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9677
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009678 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9679 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9680
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009681 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9682 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9683 for changing the default action to a reject.
9684
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009685 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9686 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9687 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9688 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009689 period.
9690
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009691 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9692 declared inline.
9693
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009694 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9695 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009696 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009697 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9698 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009699 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009700 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009701 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009702 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9703 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009704 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009705 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9706 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009707
9708 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9709 followed by some converters.
9710
9711 Example:
9712
9713 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9714
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009715 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9716 <var-name>.
9717
9718 Example:
9719
9720 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9721
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009722 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9723 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9724 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9725 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9726 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9727
9728 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9729
9730 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9731
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009732 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9733
9734 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9735
9736
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009737tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9738 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9740 no | yes | yes | no
9741 Arguments :
9742 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9743 below.
9744
9745 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9746
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009747 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009748 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9749 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9750 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9751 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9752 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9753 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9754 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009755 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009756 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9757 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9758 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9759 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9760 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9761 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9762 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9763 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9764 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9765 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9766 instead.
9767
9768 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9769 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9770 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9771 rules which may be inserted.
9772
9773 Several types of actions are supported :
9774 - accept : the request is accepted
9775 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9776 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9777 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009778 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009779 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9780 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009781 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009782 - silent-drop
9783
9784 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9785 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9786 sections for a complete description.
9787
9788 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9789 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9790 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9791
9792 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9793 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9794 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9795 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9796 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9797
9798 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9799 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9800
9801 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9802 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9803 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9804
9805 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9806 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9807 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9808
9809 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9810 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9811 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9812
9813 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9814 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9815 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9816
9817 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9818
9819 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9820
9821
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009822tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9823 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9825 no | no | yes | yes
9826 Arguments :
9827 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9828 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9829 as explained at the top of this document.
9830
9831 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9832
9833
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009834timeout check <timeout>
9835 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9836 established.
9837
9838 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9839 yes | no | yes | yes
9840 Arguments:
9841 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9842 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9843 as explained at the top of this document.
9844
9845 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9846 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009847 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009848 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009849 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9850 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9851 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009852
9853 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9854 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9855
9856 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9857 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009858 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009859
9860 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9861 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9862 forget about it.
9863
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009864 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9865 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009866
9867
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009868timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009869 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9871 yes | yes | yes | no
9872 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009873 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009874 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9875 as explained at the top of this document.
9876
9877 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9878 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9879 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009880 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9881 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9882 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9883 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009884 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9885 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9886 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009887 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009888 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009889 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9890 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009891 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9892 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009893
9894 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9895 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9896 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9897 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009898 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009899 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9900
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +01009901 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +01009902
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +02009903 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009904
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009905
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009906timeout client-fin <timeout>
9907 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9909 yes | yes | yes | no
9910 Arguments :
9911 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9912 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9913 as explained at the top of this document.
9914
9915 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9916 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9917 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9918 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9919 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9920 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9921 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +01009922 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
9923 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
9924 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009925
9926 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9927 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9928 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9929
9930 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9931
9932
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009933timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009934 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9936 yes | no | yes | yes
9937 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009938 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009939 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9940 as explained at the top of this document.
9941
9942 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009943 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009944 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009945 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009946 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9947 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009948
9949 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9950 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9951 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9952 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009953 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009954 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9955
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +02009956 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009957
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009958
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009959timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9960 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9962 yes | yes | yes | yes
9963 Arguments :
9964 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9965 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9966 as explained at the top of this document.
9967
9968 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9969 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9970 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9971 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9972 once the request has started to present itself.
9973
9974 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9975 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9976 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9977 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9978 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9979
9980 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9981 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9982 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9983 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9984
9985 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9986 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009987 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009988 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9989 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009990 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009991
9992 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9993 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9994 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9995 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9996
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +01009997 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
9998 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +01009999 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10000
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010001 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10002
10003
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010004timeout http-request <timeout>
10005 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010007 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010008 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010009 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010010 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10011 as explained at the top of this document.
10012
10013 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10014 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10015 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10016 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10017 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10018 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10019 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010020 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10021 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10022 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10023 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010024 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010025 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10026 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010027
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010028 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10029 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10030 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10031 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10032 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010033 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010034
10035 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10036 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010037 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010038 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10039 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10040
10041 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010042 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10043 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10044 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010045
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010046 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010047 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010048
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010049
10050timeout queue <timeout>
10051 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10053 yes | no | yes | yes
10054 Arguments :
10055 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10056 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10057 as explained at the top of this document.
10058
10059 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10060 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10061 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10062 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10063 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10064
10065 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10066 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10067 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10068 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10069
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010070 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010071
10072
10073timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010074 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10076 yes | no | yes | yes
10077 Arguments :
10078 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10079 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10080 as explained at the top of this document.
10081
10082 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10083 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10084 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10085 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10086 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10087 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10088 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10089
10090 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10091 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10092 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10093 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10094 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010095 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010096 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010097 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10098 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010099 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10100 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010101
10102 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10103 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10104 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10105 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010106 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010107 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10108
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010109 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010110
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010111
10112timeout server-fin <timeout>
10113 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10115 yes | no | yes | yes
10116 Arguments :
10117 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10118 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10119 as explained at the top of this document.
10120
10121 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10122 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10123 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10124 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10125 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10126 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10127 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10128 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10129 situations, it should not be needed.
10130
10131 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10132 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10133 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10134
10135 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10136
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010137
10138timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010139 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10141 yes | yes | yes | yes
10142 Arguments :
10143 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10144 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10145 as explained at the top of this document.
10146
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010147 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10148 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10149 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010150
10151 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10152 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10153 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10154 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010155 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010156
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010157 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010158
10159
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010160timeout tunnel <timeout>
10161 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10163 yes | no | yes | yes
10164 Arguments :
10165 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10166 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10167 as explained at the top of this document.
10168
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010169 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010170 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10171 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10172 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010173 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10174 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010175 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10176 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10177 specified.
10178
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010179 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10180 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10181 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10182 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10183 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10184 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10185 state.
10186
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010187 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10188 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10189 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10190 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010191 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010192
10193 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10194 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10195 forget about it.
10196
10197 Example :
10198 defaults http
10199 option http-server-close
10200 timeout connect 5s
10201 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010202 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010203 timeout server 30s
10204 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10205
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010206 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010207
10208
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010209transparent (deprecated)
10210 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010212 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010213 Arguments : none
10214
10215 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10216 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10217 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10218 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10219 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10220 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10221 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10222 appropriate server.
10223
10224 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10225
10226 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10227 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10228
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010229 See also: "option transparent"
10230
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010231unique-id-format <string>
10232 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10234 yes | yes | yes | no
10235 Arguments :
10236 <string> is a log-format string.
10237
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010238 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10239 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10240 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10241 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010242
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010243 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10244 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10245 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10246 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10247 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10248 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10249 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10250 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010251
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010252 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10253 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010254
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010255 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010256
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010257 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010258
10259 will generate:
10260
10261 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10262
10263 See also: "unique-id-header"
10264
10265unique-id-header <name>
10266 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10268 yes | yes | yes | no
10269 Arguments :
10270 <name> is the name of the header.
10271
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010272 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10273 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010274
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010275 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010276
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010277 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010278 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10279
10280 will generate:
10281
10282 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10283
10284 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010285
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010286use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010287 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10289 no | yes | yes | no
10290 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010291 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10292 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010293
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010294 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10295 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010296
10297 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10298 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10299 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010300 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010301 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010302 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10303 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010304
10305 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10306 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10307 assign the backend.
10308
10309 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10310 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10311 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10312 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10313 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10314 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10315
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010316 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010317 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010318 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10319 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10320 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10321
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010322 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10323 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10324 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10325 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10326 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10327 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10328 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10329 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10330 cannot be forced from the request.
10331
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010332 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010333 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10334 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10335
10336 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10337 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010338
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010339
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010340use-server <server> if <condition>
10341use-server <server> unless <condition>
10342 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10344 no | no | yes | yes
10345 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010346 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010347
10348 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10349
10350 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10351 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10352 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10353
10354 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10355 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10356 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10357 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10358 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10359 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10360 matches will assign the server.
10361
10362 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10363 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10364 with the next rules until one matches.
10365
10366 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10367 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10368 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10369 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10370
10371 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10372 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10373 stripped.
10374
10375 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10376 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10377 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10378 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10379
10380 Example :
10381 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10382 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10383 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10384 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10385 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10386 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010387 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010388 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10389 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10390
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010391 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010392
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010393
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100103945. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010395--------------------------
10396
10397The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10398depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10399settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10400written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10401described in this section.
10402
10403
104045.1. Bind options
10405-----------------
10406
10407The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10408as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10409no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10410parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10411while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10412provided immediately after the setting name.
10413
10414The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10415
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010416accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10417 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10418 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10419 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10420 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10421 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10422 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10423 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10424 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10425 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010426 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10427 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10428 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010429
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010430accept-proxy
10431 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010432 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10433 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010434 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10435 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10436 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10437 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010438 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010439 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10440 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010441 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10442 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010443
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010444allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010445 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010446 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010447 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010448 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10449 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010450
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010451alpn <protocols>
10452 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10453 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10454 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010455 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010456 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010457 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10458 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10459 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10460 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10461 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10462 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10463 preference, like below :
10464
10465 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010466
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010467backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010468 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010469 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10470
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010471curves <curves>
10472 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10473 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10474 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10475 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10476 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10477 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10478
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010479ecdhe <named curve>
10480 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010481 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10482 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010483
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010484ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010485 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10486 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10487 client's certificate.
10488
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010489ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10490 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10491 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10492 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10493 error is ignored.
10494
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010495ca-sign-file <cafile>
10496 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10497 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10498 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10499 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10500 'generate-certificates' for details.
10501
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010502ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010503 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10504 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10505 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10506 'generate-certificates' for details.
10507
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010508ciphers <ciphers>
10509 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10510 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010511 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010512 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010513 information and recommendations see e.g.
10514 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10515 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10516 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10517
10518ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10519 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10520 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10521 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10522 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010523 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10524 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010525
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010526crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010527 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10528 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10529 to verify client's certificate.
10530
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010531crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010532 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10533 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10534 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10535 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10536 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10537 file.
10538
10539 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10540 are loaded.
10541
10542 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010543 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010544 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10545 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10546 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10547 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010548 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10549 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010550 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010551
10552 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10553 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10554 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10555 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010556 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10557 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010558
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010559 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010560
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010561 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010562 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010563 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10564 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010565 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10566 clients).
10567
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010568 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10569 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10570 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10571 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10572 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10573 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10574 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10575 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10576 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10577 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10578 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10579 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10580 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10581
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010582 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10583 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10584 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10585 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10586 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10587
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010588 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10589 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10590 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10591 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010592
10593 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10594 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10595 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10596 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10597 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10598 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10599 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10600 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10601 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10602
10603 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10604
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010605 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010606 a cert bundle.
10607
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010608 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010609 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10610 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10611 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10612 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10613 provide multi-cert support.
10614
10615 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10616
10617 Filename | CN | SAN
10618 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10619 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010620 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010621 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10622 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10623
10624 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10625 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10626 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10627 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010628 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10629 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10630 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010631
10632 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10633 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10634
10635 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10636 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10637 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10638
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010639crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010640 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010641 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010642 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010643 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010644
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010645crt-list <file>
10646 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010647 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10648 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010649
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010650 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10651
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010652 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10653 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010654 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010655 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010656
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010657 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10658 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10659 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10660 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10661 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10662 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10663 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10664 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010665
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010666 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010667 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010668 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10669 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10670 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010671
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010672 crt-list file example:
10673 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010674 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010675 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010676 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010677
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010678defer-accept
10679 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10680 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10681 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010682 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010683 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10684 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10685 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10686 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10687 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10688 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10689 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10690
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010691expose-fd listeners
10692 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10693 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010694 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10695 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010696 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010697
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010698force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010699 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010700 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010701 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010702 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010703
10704force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010705 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010706 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010707 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010708
10709force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010710 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010711 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010712 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010713
10714force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010715 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010716 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010717 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010718
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010719force-tlsv13
10720 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10721 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010722 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010723
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010724generate-certificates
10725 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10726 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10727 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10728 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10729 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10730 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10731 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10732 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10733 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10734 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10735 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10736
10737 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10738 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010739 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010740 certificate is used many times.
10741
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010742gid <gid>
10743 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10744 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10745 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10746 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10747 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10748
10749group <group>
10750 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10751 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10752 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10753 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10754 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10755
10756id <id>
10757 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10758 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10759 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10760 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10761
10762interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010763 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10764 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10765 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10766 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10767 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10768 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010010769 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
10770 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
10771 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
10772 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
10773 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
10774 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010775
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010776level <level>
10777 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10778 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10779 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010780 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010781 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10782 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10783 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010784 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010785 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010786 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010787 all counters).
10788
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020010789severity-output <format>
10790 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
10791 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
10792 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
10793 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
10794 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
10795 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
10796 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
10797 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
10798 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
10799 rfc5424 convention.
10800
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010801maxconn <maxconn>
10802 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10803 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10804 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10805 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10806 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10807 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10808 eat all memory.
10809
10810mode <mode>
10811 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10812 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10813 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10814 UNIX sockets.
10815
10816mss <maxseg>
10817 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10818 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10819 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10820 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10821 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10822 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10823 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10824 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10825 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10826 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10827 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10828
10829name <name>
10830 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10831 page.
10832
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010833namespace <name>
10834 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10835 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10836 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10837 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10838
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010839nice <nice>
10840 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10841 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10842 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10843 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10844 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10845 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10846 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10847 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10848 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10849 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10850 one for an RDP socket.
10851
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010852no-ca-names
10853 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10854 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
10855
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010856no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010857 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010858 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010859 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010860 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010861 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
10862 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010863
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010864no-tls-tickets
10865 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10866 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10867 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010868 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10869 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010870
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010871no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010872 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010873 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010874 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010875 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010876 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10877 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010878
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010879no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010880 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010881 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010882 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010883 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010884 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10885 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010886
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010887no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010888 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010889 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010890 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010891 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010892 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10893 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010894
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010895no-tlsv13
10896 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10897 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
10898 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
10899 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010900 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10901 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010902
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010903npn <protocols>
10904 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10905 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10906 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010907 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010908 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010909 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
10910 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
10911 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
10912 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
10913 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010914
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000010915prefer-client-ciphers
10916 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
10917 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
10918 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020010919 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
10920 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
10921 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000010922
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010010923process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010010924 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010010925 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010926 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010010927 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
10928 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
10929 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
10930 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010931 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010010932 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
10933 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
10934 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
10935 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
10936 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010010937
10938 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
10939
10940 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
10941 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
10942 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
10943 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
10944 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
10945 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
10946 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
10947 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010948
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020010949proto <name>
10950 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
10951 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
10952 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
10953 in haproxy -vv.
10954 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
10955 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080010956 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020010957 h2" on the bind line.
10958
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010959ssl
10960 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010961 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010962 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10963 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020010964 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
10965 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010966
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010967ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10968 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
10969 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10970 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
10971
10972ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10973 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
10974 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10975 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
10976
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010977strict-sni
10978 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10979 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10980 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10981 See the "crt" option for more information.
10982
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010983tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010984 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010985 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10986 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010987 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010988 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10989 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10990 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10991 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10992 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10993 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10994 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10995
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010996tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010997 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010998 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10999 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11000 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11001 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11002 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11003 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11004 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011005 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11006 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11007 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011008
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011009tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11010 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011011 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11012 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11013 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11014 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11015 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11016 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11017 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11018 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11019 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11020 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011021 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11022 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11023
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011024transparent
11025 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11026 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11027 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11028 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11029 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11030 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11031 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11032 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11033 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11034 so check for support with your vendor.
11035
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011036v4v6
11037 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11038 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11039 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11040 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011041 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011042
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011043v6only
11044 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11045 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11046 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011047 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11048 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011049
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011050uid <uid>
11051 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11052 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11053 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11054 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11055 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11056
11057user <user>
11058 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11059 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11060 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11061 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11062 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11063
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011064verify [none|optional|required]
11065 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11066 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11067 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11068 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11069 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011070 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11071 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11072 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11073 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011074
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200110755.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011076------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011077
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011078The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11079which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11080arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11081settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11082after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11083Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11084address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011085
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011086 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011087 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011088
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011089Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11090keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11091
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011092The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011093
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011094addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011095 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011096 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11097 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11098 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11099 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11100 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011101
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011102agent-check
11103 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011104 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011105 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11106 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11107 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011108
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011109 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011110 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011111 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11112 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11113 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011114
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011115 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11116 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11117 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11118 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11119 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011120
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011121 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011122 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011123
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011124 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11125 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11126 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011127
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011128 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11129 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11130 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011131
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011132 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11133 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11134 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11135 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11136 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011137 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011138 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011139
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011140 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11141 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011142
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011143 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11144 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11145 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11146 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11147 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11148 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11149 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11150 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11151 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011152
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011153 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11154 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011155 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11156 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11157 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011158 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011159
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011160 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011161 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011162
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011163agent-send <string>
11164 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11165 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11166 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11167 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11168 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11169
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011170agent-inter <delay>
11171 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11172 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11173
11174 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11175 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11176 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11177 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11178 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11179 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11180 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11181 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11182 of backends use the same servers.
11183
11184 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11185
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011186agent-addr <addr>
11187 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11188
11189 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11190 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11191 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11192 hostname, it will be resolved.
11193
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011194agent-port <port>
11195 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11196
11197 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11198
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011199allow-0rtt
11200 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011201 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11202 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011203
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011204alpn <protocols>
11205 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11206 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11207 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011208 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011209 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11210 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11211 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11212 now obsolete NPN extension.
11213 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11214 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11215
11216 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011218backup
11219 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11220 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11221 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11222 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011223 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11224 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011225
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011226ca-file <cafile>
11227 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11228 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11229 server's certificate.
11230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011231check
11232 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011233 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11234 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11235 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11236 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11237 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11238 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11239 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011240 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11241 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011242 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11243 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011244
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011245check-send-proxy
11246 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11247 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11248 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11249 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11250 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11251 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11252 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11253
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011254check-alpn <protocols>
11255 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11256 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11257 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11258
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011259check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011260 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011261 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11262 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011263
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011264check-ssl
11265 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11266 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11267 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11268 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011269 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011270 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11271 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011272 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011273 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11274 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011275
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011276check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011277 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011278 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11279 for normal traffic.
11280
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011281ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011282 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11283 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11284 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011285 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11286 information and recommendations see e.g.
11287 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11288 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11289 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011290
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011291ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11292 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11293 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11294 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11295 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011296 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11297 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11298 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011299
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011300cookie <value>
11301 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11302 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11303 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11304 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11305 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11306 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11307 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11308
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011309crl-file <crlfile>
11310 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11311 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11312 to verify server's certificate.
11313
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011314crt <cert>
11315 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11316 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11317 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11318 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11319 certificate request.
11320
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011321disabled
11322 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11323 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11324 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11325 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11326 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011327 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011328
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011329enabled
11330 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11331 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11332 default value.
11333 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11334 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011335
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011336error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011337 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11338 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11339 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011340
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011341 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011342
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011343fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011344 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11345 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11346 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11347
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011348force-sslv3
11349 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11350 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011351 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011352 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011353
11354force-tlsv10
11355 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011356 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011357 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011358
11359force-tlsv11
11360 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011361 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011362 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011363
11364force-tlsv12
11365 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011366 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011367 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011368
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011369force-tlsv13
11370 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11371 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011372 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011373
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011374id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011375 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11376 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11377 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011378
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011379init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11380 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11381 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011382 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011383 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11384 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11385 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11386 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11387 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11388 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11389 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11390 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11391 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011392 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011393 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11394 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11395 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11396 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11397 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11398 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011399 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011400
11401 Example:
11402 defaults
11403 # never fail on address resolution
11404 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11405
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011406inter <delay>
11407fastinter <delay>
11408downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011409 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11410 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11411 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11412 between checks depending on the server state :
11413
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011414 Server state | Interval used
11415 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11416 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11417 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11418 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11419 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11420 or yet unchecked. |
11421 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11422 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11423 | "inter" otherwise.
11424 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011425
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011426 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11427 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11428 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11429 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011430 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11431 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11432 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11433 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11434 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011435
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011436maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011437 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11438 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11439 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11440 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11441 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11442 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11443 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11444 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11445
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011446maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011447 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11448 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11449 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11450 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11451 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11452 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11453 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11454
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011455max-reuse <count>
11456 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11457 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11458 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11459 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11460 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11461 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11462 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11463 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11464
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011465minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011466 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11467 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11468 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11469 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11470 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11471 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011472 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011473 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011474
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011475namespace <name>
11476 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11477 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11478 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11479 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11480
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011481no-agent-check
11482 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11483 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11484 default value.
11485 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11486 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11487
11488no-backup
11489 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11490 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11491 default value.
11492 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11493 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11494
11495no-check
11496 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11497 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11498 default value.
11499 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11500 "default-server" "check" setting.
11501
11502no-check-ssl
11503 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11504 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11505 default value.
11506 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11507 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11508
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011509no-send-proxy
11510 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11511 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11512 default value.
11513 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11514 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11515
11516no-send-proxy-v2
11517 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11518 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11519 default value.
11520 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11521 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11522
11523no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11524 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11525 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11526 default value.
11527 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11528 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11529
11530no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11531 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11532 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11533 default value.
11534 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11535 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11536
11537no-ssl
11538 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11539 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11540 default value.
11541 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11542 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11543
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011544no-ssl-reuse
11545 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11546 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11547 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11548 and for paranoid users.
11549
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011550no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011551 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11552 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011553 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011554
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011555 Supported in default-server: No
11556
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011557no-tls-tickets
11558 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11559 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11560 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011561 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11562 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011563 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011564
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011565no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011566 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011567 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11568 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011569 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11570 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011571 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011572
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011573 Supported in default-server: No
11574
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011575no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011576 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011577 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11578 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011579 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11580 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011581 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011582
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011583 Supported in default-server: No
11584
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011585no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011586 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011587 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11588 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011589 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11590 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011591 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011592
11593 Supported in default-server: No
11594
11595no-tlsv13
11596 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11597 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11598 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11599 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11600 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011601 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011602
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011603 Supported in default-server: No
11604
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011605no-verifyhost
11606 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11607 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11608 default value.
11609 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11610 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011611
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020011612no-tfo
11613 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
11614 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11615 default value.
11616 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11617 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
11618
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011619non-stick
11620 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11621 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11622 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11623
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011624npn <protocols>
11625 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11626 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11627 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011628 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011629 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
11630 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11631 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
11632
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011633observe <mode>
11634 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11635 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11636 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11637 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11638 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11639 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011640 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011641
11642 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11643
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011644on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011645 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11646 Currently, four modes are available:
11647 - fastinter: force fastinter
11648 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11649 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11650 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11651 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11652
11653 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11654
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011655on-marked-down <action>
11656 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11657 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011658 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11659 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11660 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11661 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11662 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11663 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11664 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11665 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011666
11667 Actions are disabled by default
11668
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011669on-marked-up <action>
11670 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11671 Currently one action is available:
11672 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11673 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11674 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11675 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011676 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11677 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011678 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11679 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11680
11681 Actions are disabled by default
11682
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010011683pool-max-conn <max>
11684 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
11685 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
11686 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
11687 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
11688 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
11689 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
11690
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010011691pool-purge-delay <delay>
11692 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010011693 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020011694 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010011695
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011696port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011697 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11698 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11699 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11700 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11701 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11702 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11703
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020011704proto <name>
11705
11706 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
11707 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
11708 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
11709 reported in haproxy -vv.
11710 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11711 protocol for all connections established to this server.
11712
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011713redir <prefix>
11714 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11715 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11716 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11717 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11718 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11719 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11720 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11721 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011722 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011723 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011724 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11725 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11726 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11727 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11728
11729 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11730
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011731rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011732 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11733 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11734 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11735
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020011736resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
11737 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
11738 server.
11739
11740 Available options:
11741
11742 * allow-dup-ip
11743 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
11744 resolution at runtime is in operation.
11745 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
11746 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
11747 For such case, simply enable this option.
11748 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
11749
11750 * prevent-dup-ip
11751 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
11752 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
11753 same fqdn.
11754 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
11755
11756 Example:
11757 backend b_myapp
11758 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
11759 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
11760 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
11761
11762 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
11763 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
11764 it
11765 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
11766 different address
11767
11768 Default value: not set
11769
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011770resolve-prefer <family>
11771 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11772 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11773 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11774 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11775
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011776 Default value: ipv6
11777
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011778 Example:
11779
11780 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011781
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011782resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011783 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011784 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011785 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011786 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11787 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011788 configured network, another address is selected.
11789
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011790 Example:
11791
11792 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011793
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011794resolvers <id>
11795 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11796 hostname.
11797
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011798 Example:
11799
11800 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011801
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011802 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011803
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011804send-proxy
11805 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11806 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11807 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11808 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011809 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11810 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11811 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11812 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11813 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11814 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11815 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11816 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11817 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11818 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011819 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11820 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011821
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011822send-proxy-v2
11823 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11824 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11825 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11826 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020011827 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
11828 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
11829 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
11830 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011831
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010011832proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
11833 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
11834 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010011835 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
11836 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010011837 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
11838 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010011839 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010011840
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011841send-proxy-v2-ssl
11842 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11843 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11844 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11845 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11846 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11847 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11848 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011849 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11850 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011851
11852send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11853 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11854 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11855 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11856 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11857 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11858 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11859 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11860 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011861 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
11862 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011863
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011864slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011865 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11866 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11867 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11868 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11869 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11870 parameters :
11871
11872 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11873 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11874
11875 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11876 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11877 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11878 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11879
11880 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11881 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11882 seen as failed.
11883
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011884sni <expression>
11885 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11886 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11887 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11888 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020011889 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
11890 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011891 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010011892 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
11893 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011894
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011895source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011896source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011897source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011898 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11899 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11900 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11901 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11902
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011903 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11904 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11905 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11906 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11907 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11908 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11909 server.
11910
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011911 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11912 specifying the source address without port(s).
11913
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011914ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011915 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11916 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11917 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11918 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11919 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11920 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011921 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11922 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011923
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011924ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11925 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
11926 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11927 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11928
11929ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11930 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
11931 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11932 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11933
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011934ssl-reuse
11935 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
11936 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11937 default value.
11938 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11939 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
11940
11941stick
11942 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
11943 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11944 default value.
11945 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11946 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011947
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011948socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011949 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011950 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
11951 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
11952
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011953tcp-ut <delay>
11954 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11955 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11956 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011957 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011958 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11959 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11960 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11961 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11962 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11963 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11964 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11965 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11966 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11967
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010011968tfo
11969 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
11970 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
11971 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
11972 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
11973 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020011974 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010011975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011976track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011977 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11978 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11979 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11980 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011981 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11982
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011983tls-tickets
11984 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
11985 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11986 default value.
11987 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11988 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011989
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011990verify [none|required]
11991 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011992 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011993 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
11994 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011995 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011996 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
11997 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
11998 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
11999 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12000 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12001 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12002 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12003 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012004
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012005verifyhost <hostname>
12006 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012007 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12008 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12009 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12010 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12011 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12012 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12013 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12014 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012015
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012016weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012017 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12018 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12019 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012020 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12021 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12022 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12023 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12024 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12025 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012026
12027
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200120285.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12029-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012030
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012031HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12032using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12033configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012034This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12035can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12036workload.
12037This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12038resolution at run time.
12039Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12040carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12041
12042
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200120435.3.1. Global overview
12044----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012045
12046As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12047different steps of the process life:
12048
12049 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12050 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12051 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12052
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012053 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12054 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012055
12056A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12057 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12058 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12059 resolution to know this new IP.
12060
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012061When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012062HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012063SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12064from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12065will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12066will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012067
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012068A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012069 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012070 first valid response.
12071
12072 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12073 servers return an error.
12074
12075
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200120765.3.2. The resolvers section
12077----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012078
12079This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012080HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12081contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012082
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012083When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12084uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12085is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12086answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12087
12088When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012089used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012090
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012091 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12092 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12093 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012094
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012095 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12096 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012097
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012098 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12099 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12100 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012101
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012102For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12103following scenarios are possible:
12104
12105 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12106 ignored
12107
12108 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12109 applied
12110
12111 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12112 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12113
12114 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12115 retries the query with a new type
12116
12117 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12118 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012119
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012120As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12121a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012122<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012123
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012124
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012125resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012126 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012127
12128A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12129
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012130accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012131 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012132 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012133 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12134 by RFC 6891)
12135
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012136 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12137
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012138nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12139 DNS server description:
12140 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12141 <ip> : IP address of the server
12142 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12143
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012144parse-resolv-conf
12145 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12146 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12147 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12148
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012149hold <status> <period>
12150 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12151 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012152 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012153 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012154 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12155 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12156 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12157
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012158 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012159
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012160resolve_retries <nb>
12161 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12162 giving up.
12163 Default value: 3
12164
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012165 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12166 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12167 type.
12168
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012169timeout <event> <time>
12170 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12171 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12172 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012173 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12174 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012175 Default value: 1s
12176 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012177 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012178 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012179 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12180 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12181
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012182 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012183
12184 resolvers mydns
12185 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12186 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012187 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012188 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012189 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012190 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012191 hold other 30s
12192 hold refused 30s
12193 hold nx 30s
12194 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012195 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012196 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012197
12198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121996. HTTP header manipulation
12200---------------------------
12201
12202In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12203response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12204request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12205which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012206against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012207
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012208If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12209to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12210but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12211HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12212stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12213because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12214a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12215still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012216
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012217This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12218in section 4.2 :
12219
12220 - reqadd <string>
12221 - reqallow <search>
12222 - reqiallow <search>
12223 - reqdel <search>
12224 - reqidel <search>
12225 - reqdeny <search>
12226 - reqideny <search>
12227 - reqpass <search>
12228 - reqipass <search>
12229 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12230 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12231 - reqtarpit <search>
12232 - reqitarpit <search>
12233 - rspadd <string>
12234 - rspdel <search>
12235 - rspidel <search>
12236 - rspdeny <search>
12237 - rspideny <search>
12238 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12239 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12240
12241With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12242is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12243parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12244prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12245Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12246
12247 \t for a tab
12248 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12249 \n for a new line (LF)
12250 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12251 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12252 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12253 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12254 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12255
12256The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12257portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12258above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12259regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
122609 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12261is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12262
12263The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12264after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12265
12266Notes related to these keywords :
12267---------------------------------
12268 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12269 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12270 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12271
12272 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12273 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12274 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12275
12276 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12277 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12278 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12279 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12280 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12281
12282 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12283 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12284 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12285 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12286 useless headers before adding new ones.
12287
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012288 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012289 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12290
12291 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12292 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12293 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12294
12295 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12296 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012297 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012298
12299
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200123006. Cache
12301---------
12302
12303HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
12304(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
12305RAM.
12306
12307The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
12308this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
12309
12310If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
12311independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
12312when we try to allocate a new one.
12313
12314The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
12315
12316It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
12317"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
12318for more details.
12319
12320When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
12321replaced by "<CACHE>".
12322
12323
123246.1. Limitation
12325----------------
12326
12327The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
12328
12329- If the response is not a 200
12330- If the response contains a Vary header
12331- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
12332- If the response is not cacheable
12333
12334- If the request is not a GET
12335- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
12336- If the request contains an Authorization header
12337
12338
123396.2. Setup
12340-----------
12341
12342To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
12343the corresponding http-request and response actions.
12344
12345
123466.2.1. Cache section
12347---------------------
12348
12349cache <name>
12350 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
12351 size of cache is mandatory.
12352
12353total-max-size <megabytes>
12354 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
12355 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
12356
12357max-object-size <bytes>
12358 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
12359 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
12360 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
12361
12362max-age <seconds>
12363 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
12364 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
12365 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
12366 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
12367 default.
12368
12369
123706.2.2. Proxy section
12371---------------------
12372
12373http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12374 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
12375 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
12376 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
12377 after this one.
12378
12379http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12380 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
12381 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
12382 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
12383 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
12384
12385
12386Example:
12387
12388 backend bck1
12389 mode http
12390
12391 http-request cache-use foobar
12392 http-response cache-store foobar
12393 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
12394
12395 cache foobar
12396 total-max-size 4
12397 max-age 240
12398
12399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200124007. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12401----------------------------------
12402
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012403HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012404client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12405The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12406these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12407but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12408data called patterns.
12409
12410
124117.1. ACL basics
12412---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012413
12414The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12415content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12416from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12417simple :
12418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012419 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012420 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012421 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12422 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012424The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12425adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012426
12427In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012429 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012430
12431This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12432Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12433and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012434an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12435conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12436as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12437are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012438
12439ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12440'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12441which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12442
12443There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12444performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012446The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12447specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12448this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012449methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12450ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012451
12452Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12453 - boolean
12454 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12455 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12456 - string
12457 - data block
12458
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012459Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12460converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12461would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12462The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12463which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12464
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012465Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12466keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12467fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12468which are summarized in the table below :
12469
12470 +---------------------+-----------------+
12471 | Sample or converter | Default |
12472 | output type | matching method |
12473 +---------------------+-----------------+
12474 | boolean | bool |
12475 +---------------------+-----------------+
12476 | integer | int |
12477 +---------------------+-----------------+
12478 | ip | ip |
12479 +---------------------+-----------------+
12480 | string | str |
12481 +---------------------+-----------------+
12482 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12483 +---------------------+-----------------+
12484
12485Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12486matching method, see below.
12487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012488The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12489 - boolean
12490 - integer or integer range
12491 - IP address / network
12492 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12493 - regular expression
12494 - hex block
12495
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012496The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12497
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012498 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12499 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012500 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012501 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012502 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012503 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012504 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012506The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12507read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12508if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12509lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12510will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12511beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12512a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12513lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12514exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12515
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012516The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12517parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12518ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12519a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12520check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12521
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012522The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12523socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12524file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012526Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12527loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12528
12529 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12530
12531In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12532the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12533case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12534as well.
12535
12536The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12537sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12538do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12539methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12540is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012541obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012542followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12543default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12544that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12545string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12546
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012547The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12548By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12549string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12550resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12551server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012552waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012553flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12554function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012556There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12557sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12558be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012559
12560 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12561 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012562 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12563 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12564 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12565 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012566
12567 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12568 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012569 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012570
12571 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012572 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012573
12574 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012575 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012576
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012577 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012578 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12579
12580 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12581 binary or string samples.
12582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012583 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12584 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012586 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12587 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12588 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012590 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12591 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012593 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12594 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012596 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12597 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012599 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12600 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012601 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012603 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12604 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12605 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012606
12607For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12608request, it is possible to do :
12609
12610 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12611
12612In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12613buffer, one would use the following acl :
12614
12615 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12616
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012617On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12618possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12619
12620 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012622All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12623criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12624method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12625to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12626criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12627the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012629If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012630the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12631For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012633 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12634 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12635 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12636 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012637
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012638
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012639The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12640types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12641combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12642brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12643default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012645 +-------------------------------------------------+
12646 | Input sample type |
12647 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012648 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012649 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12650 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12651 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012652 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012653 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012654 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012655 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012656 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012657 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012658 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012659 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012660 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012661 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012662 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012663 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012664 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012665 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012666 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012667 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012668 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012669 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012670 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012671 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012672 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012673 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12674 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12675 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012676
12677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126787.1.1. Matching booleans
12679------------------------
12680
12681In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12682Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12683When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12684that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12685
12686Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12687return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12688"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12689
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126917.1.2. Matching integers
12692------------------------
12693
12694Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12695enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12696to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12697
12698Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12699matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12700lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012701
12702For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12703unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12704representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12705
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012706As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12707two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12708instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12709ranges and operators.
12710
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012711For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012712operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12713Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12714of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012715
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012716Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012717
12718 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12719 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12720 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12721 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12722 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12723
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012724For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012725
12726 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12727
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012728This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12729
12730 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12731
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200127337.1.3. Matching strings
12734-----------------------
12735
12736String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12737different forms :
12738
12739 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012740 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012741
12742 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012743 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012744
12745 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12746 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12747
12748 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12749 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12750
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012751 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012752 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12753 matches.
12754
12755 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12756 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12757 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012758
12759String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12760exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12761characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12762string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12763to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012764before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012765
12766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200127677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12768---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012769
12770Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12771they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12772possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12773passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12774the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012775the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12776match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012777
12778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200127797.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12780-------------------------------------
12781
12782It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12783not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12784a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12785to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12786digits may be used upper or lower case.
12787
12788Example :
12789 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12790 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12791
12792
127937.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12794---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012795
12796IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12797netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12798within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012799host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012800difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12801at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12802does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12803parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012804
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012805The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12806abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12807
12808 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12809 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12810 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12811 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12812 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12813 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12814 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12815 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12816
12817Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12818192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12819
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012820IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12821Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12822trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12823IPv6 patterns.
12824
12825HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12826following situations :
12827 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12828 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12829 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12830 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12831 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12832 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12833 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12834 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12835 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12836 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012838
128397.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12840----------------------------------
12841
12842Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12843combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12844
12845 - AND (implicit)
12846 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12847 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012849A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012851 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012853Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12854indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012856For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12857"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12858requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12859is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12860
12861 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012862 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12863 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12864 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012865
12866To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12867and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12868
12869 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12870 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12871 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12872 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12873
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012874 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012875 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12876 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12877 use_backend www if host_www
12878
12879It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12880expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12881be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12882the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12883
12884 The following rule :
12885
12886 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012887 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012888
12889 Can also be written that way :
12890
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012891 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012892
12893It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12894to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12895simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12896sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12897good use is the following :
12898
12899 With named ACLs :
12900
12901 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12902 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12903 monitor fail if site_dead
12904
12905 With anonymous ACLs :
12906
12907 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12908
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012909See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12910keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012911
12912
129137.3. Fetching samples
12914---------------------
12915
12916Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12917against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12918sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12919ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12920of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12921available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12922
12923This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12924Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12925compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12926deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12927
12928The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12929matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12930method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12931indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12932
12933As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12934when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12935mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12936the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12937ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12938
12939Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12940multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12941when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012942incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12943are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012944is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12945all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12946
12947Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12948 - name
12949 - name(arg1)
12950 - name(arg1,arg2)
12951
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012952
129537.3.1. Converters
12954-----------------
12955
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012956Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12957of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12958is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12959was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012960has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012961unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12962
12963These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12964sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12965the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012966support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012967
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012968A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12969support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12970supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12971(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12972bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012974The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012975
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001297651d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12977 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12978 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12979 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12980 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12981 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12982
12983 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012984 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
12985 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000012986 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12987 frontend http-in
12988 bind *:8081
12989 default_backend servers
12990 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12991 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12992
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012993add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012994 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012995 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012996 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12997 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012998 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012999 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13000 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13001 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13002 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013003 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013004 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013005
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013006aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13007 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13008 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13009 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13010 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13011 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13012 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13013
13014 Example:
13015 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13016 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13017
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013018and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013019 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013020 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013021 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13022 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013023 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013024 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13025 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13026 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13027 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013028 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013029 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013030
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013031b64dec
13032 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13033 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13034
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013035base64
13036 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013037 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013038 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13039
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013040bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013041 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013042 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013043 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013044 presence of a flag).
13045
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013046bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13047 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13048 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013049 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013050
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013051concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13052 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13053 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13054 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13055 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13056 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13057 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13058 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13059 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13060 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13061 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013062 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013063 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013064 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013065
13066 Example:
13067 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13068 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13069 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13070 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13071
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013072cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013073 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13074 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013075
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013076crc32([<avalanche>])
13077 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13078 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13079 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13080 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13081 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13082 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13083 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13084 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13085 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13086 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013087 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13088
13089crc32c([<avalanche>])
13090 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13091 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13092 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13093 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13094 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13095 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13096 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13097 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013098
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013099da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013100 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13101 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13102 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13103 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013104 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013105 configuration language.
13106
13107 Example:
13108 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013109 bind *:8881
13110 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013111 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013112
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013113debug
13114 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13115 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13116 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13117
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013118div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013119 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13120 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013121 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013122 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13123 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013124 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013125 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13126 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13127 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13128 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013129 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013130 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013131
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013132djb2([<avalanche>])
13133 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13134 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13135 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13136 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13137 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13138 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13139 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013140 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13141 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013142
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013143even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013144 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013145 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13146
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013147field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13148 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13149 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13150 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13151 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13152 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13153 fields.
13154
13155 Example :
13156 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13157 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13158 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13159 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13160 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013161
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013162hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013163 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013164 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013165 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013166 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013167
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013168hex2i
13169 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013170 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013171
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013172http_date([<offset>])
13173 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13174 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13175 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13176 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13177 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13178 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013179
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013180in_table(<table>)
13181 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13182 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13183 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013184 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013185 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13186
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013187ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13188 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013189 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013190 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13191 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13192 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13193 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13194 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013195
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013196json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013197 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013198 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013199 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013200 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13201 of errors:
13202 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13203 bytes, ...)
13204 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13205 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13206
13207 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13208 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13209 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13210 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13211 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13212 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013213 - "ascii" : never fails;
13214 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13215 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013216 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013217 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013218 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13219 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13220
13221 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013222 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013223
13224 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013225 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013226 capture request header user-agent len 150
13227 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013228
13229 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13230 GET / HTTP/1.0
13231 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13232
13233 Output log:
13234 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13235
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013236language(<value>[,<default>])
13237 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13238 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13239 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13240 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13241 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13242 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13243 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13244 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13245 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013246 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013247 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13248 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013249
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013250 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013251
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013252 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13253 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013254
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013255 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13256 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13257 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13258 use_backend spanish if es
13259 use_backend french if fr
13260 use_backend english if en
13261 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013262
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013263length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013264 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13265 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13266 type. The result is of type integer.
13267
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013268lower
13269 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13270 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13271 type. The result is of type string.
13272
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013273ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13274 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13275 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13276 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13277 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13278 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13279 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13280
13281 Example :
13282
13283 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013284 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013285 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13286
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013287map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13288map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13289map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13290 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13291 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13292 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13293 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13294 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13295 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13296 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13297 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013298
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013299 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13300 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13301 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013302
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013303 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013304 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013305
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013306 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13307 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13308 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13309 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013310 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13311 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013312 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13313 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13314 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13315 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13316 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13317 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13318 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13319 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013320 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13321 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13322 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013323 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13324 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13325 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13326 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13327 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013328
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013329 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13330 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13331 the corresponding match text.
13332
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013333 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13334 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13335 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13336 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13337 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013338
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013339 Example :
13340
13341 # this is a comment and is ignored
13342 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13343 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13344 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13345 | | | `---------- value
13346 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13347 | `---------------------------- key
13348 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13349
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013350mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013351 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13352 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013353 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013354 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013355 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013356 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13357 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13358 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13359 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013360 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013361 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013362
13363mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013364 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013365 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13366 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013367 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013368 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013369 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013370 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13371 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13372 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13373 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013374 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013375 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013376
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013377nbsrv
13378 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13379 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13380 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13381 map lookup.
13382
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013383neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013384 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13385 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13386 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13387 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013388
13389not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013390 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013391 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013392 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013393 absence of a flag).
13394
13395odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013396 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013397 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13398
13399or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013400 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013401 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013402 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13403 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013404 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013405 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13406 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13407 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13408 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013409 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013410 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013411
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013412protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13413 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13414 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13415 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13416 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13417 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13418 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13419 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13420 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13421 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13422 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13423 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13424
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013425regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013426 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13427 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13428 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13429 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13430 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13431 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13432 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13433 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13434 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13435 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013436 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13437 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13438 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13439 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013440
13441 Example :
13442
13443 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13444 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13445 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13446 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13447
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013448capture-req(<id>)
13449 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13450 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13451
13452 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013453 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13454 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013455
13456capture-res(<id>)
13457 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13458 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13459
13460 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013461 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13462 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013463
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013464sdbm([<avalanche>])
13465 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13466 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13467 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13468 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13469 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13470 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13471 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013472 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13473 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013474
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013475set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013476 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13477 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13478 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013479 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013480 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13481 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013482 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013483 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13484 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013485 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013486 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013487
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013488sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013489 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013490 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13491
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013492sha2([<bits>])
13493 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
13494 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
13495
13496 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
13497 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
13498
13499 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
13500 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
13501
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013502strcmp(<var>)
13503 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13504 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13505 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13506 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13507 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13508 shorter).
13509
13510 Example :
13511
13512 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13513 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13514 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13515
13516
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013517sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013518 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13519 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013520 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013521 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13522 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013523 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013524 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13525 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013526 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013527 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13528 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013529 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013530 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013531
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013532table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13533 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13534 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13535 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13536 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13537 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13538 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13539
13540
13541table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13542 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13543 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13544 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13545 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13546 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13547 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13548
13549table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13550 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13551 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013552 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013553 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13554 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13555
13556table_conn_cur(<table>)
13557 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13558 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13559 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13560 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13561 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13562
13563table_conn_rate(<table>)
13564 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13565 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13566 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13567 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13568 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13569
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013570table_gpt0(<table>)
13571 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13572 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13573 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13574 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13575 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13576
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013577table_gpc0(<table>)
13578 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13579 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13580 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13581 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13582 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13583
13584table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13585 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13586 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13587 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13588 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13589 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13590 sample fetch keyword.
13591
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013592table_gpc1(<table>)
13593 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13594 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13595 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13596 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13597 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13598
13599table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13600 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13601 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13602 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13603 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13604 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13605 sample fetch keyword.
13606
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013607table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13608 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13609 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013610 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013611 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13612 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13613
13614table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13615 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13616 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13617 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13618 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13619 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13620 keyword.
13621
13622table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13623 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13624 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013625 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013626 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13627 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13628
13629table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13630 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13631 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13632 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13633 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13634 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13635 keyword.
13636
13637table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13638 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13639 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013640 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013641 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13642 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13643 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13644 keyword.
13645
13646table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13647 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13648 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013649 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013650 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13651 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13652 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13653 keyword.
13654
13655table_server_id(<table>)
13656 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13657 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13658 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13659 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13660 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13661 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13662
13663table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13664 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13665 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013666 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013667 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13668 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13669 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13670 keyword.
13671
13672table_sess_rate(<table>)
13673 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13674 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13675 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13676 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13677 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13678 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13679 keyword.
13680
13681table_trackers(<table>)
13682 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13683 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13684 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13685 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13686 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13687 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13688 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13689 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13690 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13691 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13692
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013693upper
13694 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13695 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13696 type. The result is of type string.
13697
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013698url_dec
13699 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13700 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13701
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013702ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013703 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013704 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
13705 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
13706 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013707 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13708 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13709 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13710 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013711 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013712 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13713 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013714
13715 Example:
13716 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
13717 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
13718
13719 message Point {
13720 int32 latitude = 1;
13721 int32 longitude = 2;
13722 }
13723
13724 message PPoint {
13725 Point point = 59;
13726 }
13727
13728 message Rectangle {
13729 // One corner of the rectangle.
13730 PPoint lo = 48;
13731 // The other corner of the rectangle.
13732 PPoint hi = 49;
13733 }
13734
13735 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
13736 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
13737 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
13738
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013739 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13740 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013741 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013742 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
13743
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013744 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013745
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013746 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013747
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013748 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013749 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13750 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
13751
13752 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
13753 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
13754 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
13755
13756 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
13757 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
13758 interpret the previous binary sample.
13759
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013760
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013761unset-var(<var name>)
13762 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13763 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13764 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13765 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13766 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13767 response),
13768 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13769 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13770 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13771 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13772
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013773utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13774 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13775 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13776 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13777 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13778 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13779 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13780
13781 Example :
13782
13783 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013784 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013785 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13786
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013787word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13788 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13789 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13790 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13791 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13792 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13793
13794 Example :
13795 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13796 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13797 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13798 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13799 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013800
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013801wt6([<avalanche>])
13802 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13803 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13804 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13805 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13806 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13807 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13808 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013809 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
13810 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013811
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013812xor(<value>)
13813 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013814 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013815 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013816 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013817 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013818 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13819 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013820 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013821 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13822 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013823 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013824 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013825
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013826xxh32([<seed>])
13827 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13828 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13829 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13830 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13831 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13832 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13833 as cryptographically secure.
13834
13835xxh64([<seed>])
13836 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13837 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13838 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13839 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13840 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13841 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13842 as cryptographically secure.
13843
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013844
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200138457.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013846--------------------------------------------
13847
13848A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13849not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13850"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13851The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13852
13853always_false : boolean
13854 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13855 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13856
13857always_true : boolean
13858 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13859 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13860
13861avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013862 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013863 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13864 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13865 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13866 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13867 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13868 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13869 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13870 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13871 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13872 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13873 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13874 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13875 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013877be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013878 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13879 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13880 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13881 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040013882 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
13883
13884be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
13885 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
13886 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
13887 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
13888 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
13889 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040013890 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
13891 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040013892
13893 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
13894 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
13895 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013897be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13898 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13899 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13900 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013901 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013902 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13903 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013904
13905 Example :
13906 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13907 backend dynamic
13908 mode http
13909 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13910 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013911
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013912bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013913 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13914 of the string.
13915
13916bool(<bool>) : bool
13917 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13918 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013920connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13921 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013922 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013923 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13924 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013925
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013926 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013927 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013928 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13929
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013930 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13931 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013932
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013933 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013934 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013935 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013936 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013937 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013938 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013939 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013940
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013941 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13942 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013943 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013944 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013945
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010013946cpu_calls : integer
13947 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
13948 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
13949 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
13950 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
13951 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
13952 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
13953
13954cpu_ns_avg : integer
13955 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
13956 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
13957 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
13958 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
13959 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
13960 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
13961 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
13962 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
13963 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
13964 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
13965 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
13966
13967cpu_ns_tot : integer
13968 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
13969 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
13970 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
13971 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
13972 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
13973 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
13974 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
13975 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
13976 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
13977 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
13978 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
13979 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
13980 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
13981
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013982date([<offset>]) : integer
13983 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13984 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13985 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13986 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013987 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13988
13989 Example :
13990
13991 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13992 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013993
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010013994date_us : integer
13995 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
13996 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
13997 from the same timeval structure.
13998
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020013999distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14000 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14001 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14002 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14003 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14004 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14005 list of supported tokens.
14006
14007distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14008 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14009 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14010 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14011 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14012 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14013 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14014 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14015 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14016 supported tokens.
14017
14018 Example :
14019 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14020 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14021 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14022 # send large files to the big farm
14023 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14024
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014025env(<name>) : string
14026 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14027 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14028 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14029 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14030 certain way.
14031
14032 Examples :
14033 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14034 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14035
14036 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14037 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014039fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14040 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014041 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14042 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014043 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14044 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014045 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014046 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14047 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014048
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014049fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14050 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14051 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14052 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014054fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14055 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14056 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14057 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14058 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14059 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14060 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14061 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14062 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014063
14064 Example :
14065 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14066 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14067 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14068 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14069 frontend mail
14070 bind :25
14071 mode tcp
14072 maxconn 100
14073 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14074 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14075 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14076 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014077
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014078hostname : string
14079 Returns the system hostname.
14080
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014081int(<integer>) : signed integer
14082 Returns a signed integer.
14083
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014084ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14085 Returns an ipv4.
14086
14087ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14088 Returns an ipv6.
14089
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014090lat_ns_avg : integer
14091 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14092 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14093 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14094 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14095 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14096 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14097 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14098 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14099 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14100 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14101 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14102 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14103 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14104 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14105
14106lat_ns_tot : integer
14107 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14108 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14109 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14110 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14111 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14112 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14113 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14114 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14115 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14116 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14117 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14118 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14119 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14120 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14121 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14122 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14123 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14124 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14125 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14126
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014127meth(<method>) : method
14128 Returns a method.
14129
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014130nbproc : integer
14131 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14132 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14133 and debugging purposes.
14134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014135nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14136 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14137 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14138 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014139 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14140 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14141 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014142
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014143prio_class : integer
14144 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14145 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14146 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14147
14148prio_offset : integer
14149 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14150 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14151 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14152 set-priority-offset".
14153
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014154proc : integer
14155 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14156 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14157 debugging purposes.
14158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014159queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014160 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14161 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14162 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014163 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14164 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14165 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14166 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14167 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14168
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014169rand([<range>]) : integer
14170 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14171 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14172 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14173 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14174 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014176srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14177 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14178 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14179 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14180 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14181 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014182 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14183 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14184
14185srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14186 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14187 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14188 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14189 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14190 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14191 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14192 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14193
14194 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14195 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014196
14197srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14198 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14199 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14200 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014201 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014202 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14203 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14204 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14205
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014206srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14207 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14208 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14209 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14210 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14211 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14212 fetch methods.
14213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014214srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14215 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14216 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014217 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014218 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14219 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014220 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014221 overloading servers).
14222
14223 Example :
14224 # Redirect to a separate back
14225 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14226 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14227 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14228
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014229stopping : boolean
14230 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14231 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14232 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14233
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014234str(<string>) : string
14235 Returns a string.
14236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014237table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14238 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14239 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14240
14241table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14242 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14243 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14244 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14245
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014246thread : integer
14247 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14248 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14249 and debugging purposes.
14250
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014251var(<var-name>) : undefined
14252 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014253 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14254 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014255 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014256 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14257 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014258 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014259 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14260 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014261 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014262 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014263
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200142647.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014265----------------------------------
14266
14267The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14268closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14269methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14270sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14271TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014272the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14273counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014274"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14275used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14276can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14277Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14278table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14279tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14280currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014281
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014282bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014283 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14284 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14285 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014287be_id : integer
14288 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14289 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14290
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014291be_name : string
14292 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14293 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014295dst : ip
14296 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14297 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14298 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14299 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014300 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14301 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14302 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14303 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14304 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14305 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014306
14307dst_conn : integer
14308 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14309 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14310 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14311 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14312 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14313 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14314 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14315 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014316
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014317dst_is_local : boolean
14318 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14319 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14320 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14321 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014322 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014323 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14324 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14325 it only once per connection.
14326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014327dst_port : integer
14328 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14329 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14330 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14331 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14332 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14333 an HTTP header.
14334
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014335fc_http_major : integer
14336 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14337 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14338 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14339
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014340fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14341 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14342 header.
14343
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014344fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14345 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14346 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14347 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14348 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14349 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14350 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14351
14352fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14353 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14354 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14355 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14356 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14357 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14358 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14359
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014360fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14361 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14362 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14363 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14364 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14365
14366fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14367 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14368 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14369 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14370 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14371
14372fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14373 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14374 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14375 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14376 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14377
14378fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14379 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14380 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14381 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14382 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14383
14384fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14385 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14386 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14387 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14388 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14389
14390fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14391 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14392 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14393 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14394 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14395
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014396fe_defbe : string
14397 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14398 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014400fe_id : integer
14401 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014402 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014403 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14404
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014405fe_name : string
14406 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14407 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14408 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14409
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014410sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014411sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14412sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14413sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014414 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14415 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14416 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14417
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014418sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014419sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14420sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14421sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014422 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14423 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14424 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14425
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014426sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014427sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14428sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14429sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014430 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14431 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014432 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14433 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14434 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014435
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014436 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014437 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14438 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014439 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14440 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14441 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014442 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14443 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14444
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014445sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14446sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14447sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14448sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14449 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14450 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14451 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14452 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14453 when a first ACL was verified.
14454
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014455sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014456sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14457sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14458sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014459 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014460 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14461
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014462sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014463sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14464sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14465sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014466 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14467 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14468 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14469
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014470sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014471sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14472sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14473sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014474 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14475 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14476 See also src_conn_rate.
14477
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014478sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014479sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14480sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14481sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014482 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014483 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014484
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014485sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14486sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14487sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14488sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14489 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14490 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14491
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014492sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14493sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14494sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14495sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14496 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14497 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14498
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014499sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014500sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14501sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14502sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014503 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14504 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14505 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014506 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14507 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14508 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014509
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014510sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14511sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14512sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14513sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14514 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14515 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14516 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14517 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14518 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14519 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14520
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014521sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014522sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14523sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14524sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014525 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014526 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14527 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14528
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014529sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014530sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14531sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14532sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014533 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14534 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14535 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14536 src_http_err_rate.
14537
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014538sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014539sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14540sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14541sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014542 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014543 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14544 src_http_req_cnt.
14545
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014546sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014547sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14548sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14549sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014550 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14551 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14552 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14553 src_http_req_rate.
14554
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014555sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014556sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14557sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14558sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014559 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014560 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14561 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14562 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14563 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014564
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014565 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014566 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14567 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014568 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14569
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014570sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14571sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14572sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14573sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14574 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14575 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14576 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14577 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14578 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14579
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014580sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014581sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14582sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14583sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014584 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14585 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14586 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014587
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014588sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014589sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14590sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14591sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014592 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14593 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14594 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014595
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014596sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014597sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14598sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14599sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014600 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014601 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14602 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14603 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014604 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014605 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14606
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014607sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014608sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14609sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14610sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014611 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14612 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14613 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14614 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14615 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014616 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014617
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014618sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014619sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14620sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14621sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014622 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14623 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14624 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14625
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014626sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014627sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14628sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14629sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014630 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14631 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014632 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014633 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14634 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014635 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14636 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14637 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014639so_id : integer
14640 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14641 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14642 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014644src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014645 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014646 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14647 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14648 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014649 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14650 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14651 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014652 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14653 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14654 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14655 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14656 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14657 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14658 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014659
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014660 Example:
14661 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14662 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014664src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14665 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14666 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14667 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014668 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014670src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14671 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14672 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014673 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014674 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014676src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14677 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14678 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14679 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14680 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14681 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14682 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014683
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014684 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014685 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14686 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14687 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14688 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014689 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014690 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14691 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14692
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014693src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14694 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14695 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14696 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14697 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14698 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14699 was verified.
14700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014701src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014702 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014703 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014704 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014705 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014707src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014708 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014709 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14710 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014711 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014713src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14714 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14715 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14716 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014717 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014719src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014720 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014721 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014722 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014723 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014724
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014725src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14726 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14727 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14728 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14729 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14730
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014731src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14732 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14733 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14734 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14735 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014737src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014738 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014739 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014740 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14741 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014742 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14743 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14744 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014745
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014746src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14747 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14748 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14749 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14750 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14751 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14752 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14753 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014755src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014756 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014757 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014758 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014759 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014760 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014762src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14763 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14764 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14765 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14766 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014767 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014769src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014770 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014771 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14772 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014773 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014775src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14776 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14777 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14778 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014779 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014780 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014782src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14783 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14784 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14785 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014786 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014787 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14788 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014789
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014790 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014791 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014792 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014793 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014794
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014795src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14796 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14797 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14798 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14799 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14800 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14801 connection when a first ACL was verified.
14802
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014803src_is_local : boolean
14804 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14805 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14806 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14807 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014808 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014809 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14810 once per connection.
14811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014812src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014813 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14814 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14815 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14816 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14817 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014819src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014820 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14821 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14822 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14823 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14824 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014826src_port : integer
14827 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14828 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14829 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14830 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014832src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014833 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014834 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14835 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14836 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014837 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014839src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14840 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14841 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14842 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14843 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014844 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014846src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14847 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
14848 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
14849 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
14850 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
14851 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
14852 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
14853 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
14854 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014855
14856 Example :
14857 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
14858 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
14859 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
14860 listen ssh
14861 bind :22
14862 mode tcp
14863 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014864 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014865 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014866 server local 127.0.0.1:22
14867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014868srv_id : integer
14869 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
14870 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
14871 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020014872
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200148737.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014874----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020014875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014876The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
14877closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
14878when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
14879usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014880future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014881
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001488251d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
14883 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14884 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14885 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
14886 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14887 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14888
14889 Example :
14890 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
14891 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
14892 # the request.
14893 frontend http-in
14894 bind *:8081
14895 default_backend servers
14896 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14897 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14898
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014899ssl_bc : boolean
14900 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14901 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
14902 other a server with the "ssl" option.
14903
14904ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
14905 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
14906 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14907
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010014908ssl_bc_alpn : string
14909 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
14910 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020014911 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010014912 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14913 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14914 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
14915 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
14916 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14917 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
14918
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014919ssl_bc_cipher : string
14920 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
14921 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14922
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040014923ssl_bc_client_random : binary
14924 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
14925 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
14926 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
14927
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010014928ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
14929 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14930 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
14931 session or a TLS ticket.
14932
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010014933ssl_bc_npn : string
14934 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
14935 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020014936 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010014937 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
14938 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
14939 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
14940 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
14941 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
14942
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014943ssl_bc_protocol : string
14944 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
14945 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14946
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014947ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014948 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014949 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14950 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014951
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040014952ssl_bc_server_random : binary
14953 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
14954 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
14955 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
14956
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014957ssl_bc_session_id : binary
14958 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
14959 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
14960 if session was reused or not.
14961
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040014962ssl_bc_session_key : binary
14963 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
14964 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
14965 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
14966 BoringSSL.
14967
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014968ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
14969 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
14970 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014972ssl_c_ca_err : integer
14973 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14974 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
14975 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
14976 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
14977 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014979ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
14980 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14981 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
14982 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
14983 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014984
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014985ssl_c_der : binary
14986 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
14987 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14988 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014990ssl_c_err : integer
14991 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14992 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
14993 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
14994 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
14995 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014997ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14998 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14999 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15000 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15001 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15002 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15003 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15004 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15005 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015007ssl_c_key_alg : string
15008 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15009 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15010 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015012ssl_c_notafter : string
15013 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15014 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15015 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015017ssl_c_notbefore : string
15018 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15019 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15020 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015022ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15023 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15024 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15025 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15026 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15027 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15028 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15029 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15030 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015032ssl_c_serial : binary
15033 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15034 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15035 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015037ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15038 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15039 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15040 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015041 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15042 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15043
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015044 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015045 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015047ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15048 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15049 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15050 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015052ssl_c_used : boolean
15053 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15054 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015056ssl_c_verify : integer
15057 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15058 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15059 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15060 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015062ssl_c_version : integer
15063 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15064 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015065
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015066ssl_f_der : binary
15067 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15068 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15069 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015071ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15072 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15073 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15074 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15075 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015076 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015077 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15078 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15079 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015081ssl_f_key_alg : string
15082 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15083 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15084 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015086ssl_f_notafter : string
15087 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15088 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15089 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015091ssl_f_notbefore : string
15092 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15093 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15094 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015096ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15097 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15098 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15099 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15100 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15101 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15102 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15103 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15104 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015106ssl_f_serial : binary
15107 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15108 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15109 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015110
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015111ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15112 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15113 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15114 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015116ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15117 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15118 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15119 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015121ssl_f_version : integer
15122 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15123 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15124
15125ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015126 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15127 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15128 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015130 Example :
15131 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15132 listen http-https
15133 bind :80
15134 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15135 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15136
15137ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15138 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15139 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15140
15141ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015142 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015143 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15144 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15145 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15146 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15147 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15148 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15149 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15150 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015152ssl_fc_cipher : string
15153 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15154 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015155
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015156ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15157 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15158 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015159 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015160
15161ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15162 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15163 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015164 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015165
15166ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15167 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15168 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15169 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015170 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015171 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015172
15173ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15174 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15175 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015176 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015177
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015178ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15179 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15180 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15181 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015183ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015184 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15185 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015186 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15187 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15188 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15189 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015190
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015191ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15192 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15193 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15194 wait until the handshake happened.
15195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015196ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15197 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015198 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15199 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015200 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015201 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015202
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015203ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015204 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015205 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15206 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015208ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015209 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015210 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15211 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15212 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15213 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15214 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15215 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15216 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015218ssl_fc_protocol : string
15219 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15220 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015221
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015222ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015223 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015224 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15225 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015226
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015227ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15228 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15229 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15230 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015232ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15233 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15234 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15235 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15236 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015237
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015238ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15239 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15240 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15241 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15242 BoringSSL.
15243
15244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015245ssl_fc_sni : string
15246 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15247 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15248 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15249 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15250 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15251
15252 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15253 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15254 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015255 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015256 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015258 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015259 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15260 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015262ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15263 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15264 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015265
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015266
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200152677.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015268------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015270Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15271sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15272only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15273For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15274be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15275can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15276sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15277for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15278content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015280payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015281 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015282 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15283 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015285payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15286 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015287 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015288 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015289
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015290req.hdrs : string
15291 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15292 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15293 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15294 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15295
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015296req.hdrs_bin : binary
15297 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15298 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15299 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15300 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15301 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15302 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15303
15304 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15305
15306 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15307 str: <int:length><bytes>
15308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015309req.len : integer
15310req_len : integer (deprecated)
15311 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15312 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15313 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15314 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15315 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15316 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15317 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15318 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015320req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15321 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015322 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15323 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15324 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15325 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015327 ACL alternatives :
15328 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015330req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15331 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15332 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15333 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15334 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015336 ACL alternatives :
15337 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015339 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015341req.proto_http : boolean
15342req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15343 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15344 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15345 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15346 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15347 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15348 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15349 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015351 Example:
15352 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15353 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15354 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015355 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015357req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15358rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15359 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15360 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15361 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15362 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15363 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15364 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15365 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015367 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15368 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15369 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15370 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15371 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15372 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015374 ACL derivatives :
15375 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015377 Example :
15378 listen tse-farm
15379 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15380 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15381 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15382 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15383 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15384 persist rdp-cookie
15385 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15386 # This is only useful makes sense if
15387 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15388 stick-table type string size 204800
15389 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15390 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15391 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015393 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15394 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015396req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15397rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15398 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15399 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15400 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15401 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015403 ACL derivatives :
15404 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015405
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015406req.ssl_alpn : string
15407 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15408 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15409 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15410 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15411 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15412 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015413 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015414
15415 Examples :
15416 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15417 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15418 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015419 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015420 default_backend bk_default
15421
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015422req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15423 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15424 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015425 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15426 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15427 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15428 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15429 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015431req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15432req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15433 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15434 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15435 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15436 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15437 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15438 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15439 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015441req.ssl_sni : string
15442req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15443 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15444 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15445 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15446 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15447 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15448 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15449 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15450 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15451 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15452 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15453 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15454 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015456 ACL derivatives :
15457 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015459 Examples :
15460 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15461 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15462 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15463 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15464 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015465
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015466req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15467 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15468 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15469 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15470 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15471 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15472 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15473 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15474 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15475 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015477req.ssl_ver : integer
15478req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15479 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15480 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15481 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15482 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15483 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15484 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15485 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015486 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015487 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015489 ACL derivatives :
15490 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015491
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015492res.len : integer
15493 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15494 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15495 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15496 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15497 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15498 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15499 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15500 content inspection.
15501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015502res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15503 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015504 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15505 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15506 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15507 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015509res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15510 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15511 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15512 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15513 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015515 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015516
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015517res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15518rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15519 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15520 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15521 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15522 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15523 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15524 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15525 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015527wait_end : boolean
15528 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15529 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015530 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015531 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15532 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015533 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015534 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15535 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015537 Examples :
15538 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15539 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15540 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015542 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15543 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15544 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15545 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15546 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15547 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15548 tcp-request content reject
15549
15550
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200155517.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015552--------------------------------------
15553
15554It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15555This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15556data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15557its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15558HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15559content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15560to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15561more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15562response are indexed.
15563
15564base : string
15565 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15566 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15567 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15568 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15569 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15570 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15571 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15572 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15573
15574 ACL derivatives :
15575 base : exact string match
15576 base_beg : prefix match
15577 base_dir : subdir match
15578 base_dom : domain match
15579 base_end : suffix match
15580 base_len : length match
15581 base_reg : regex match
15582 base_sub : substring match
15583
15584base32 : integer
15585 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15586 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15587 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015588 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15589 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15590 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015591
15592base32+src : binary
15593 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15594 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15595 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15596 per-URL counters.
15597
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015598capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15599 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15600 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15601 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15602
15603capture.req.method : string
15604 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15605 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15606 because it's allocated.
15607
15608capture.req.uri : string
15609 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15610 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15611 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15612 allocated.
15613
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015614capture.req.ver : string
15615 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15616 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15617 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15618
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015619capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15620 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15621 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15622 The first entry is an index of 0.
15623 See also: "capture response header"
15624
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015625capture.res.ver : string
15626 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15627 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15628 persistent flag.
15629
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015630req.body : binary
15631 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15632 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15633 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15634 the first chunk is analyzed.
15635
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015636req.body_param([<name>) : string
15637 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15638 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15639 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15640 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15641 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15642 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15643 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15644 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15645 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15646 given.
15647
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015648req.body_len : integer
15649 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15650 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15651 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15652 "option http-buffer-request".
15653
15654req.body_size : integer
15655 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15656 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15657 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15658 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15659 "option http-buffer-request".
15660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015661req.cook([<name>]) : string
15662cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15663 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15664 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15665 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15666 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15667 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15668 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15669 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15670 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15671
15672 ACL derivatives :
15673 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15674 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15675 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15676 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15677 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15678 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15679 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15680 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015682req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15683cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15684 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15685 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015687req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15688cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15689 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15690 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15691 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15692 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015694cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15695 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15696 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15697 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15698 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015699 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015700 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15701 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15702 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15703 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015705hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15706 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15707 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15708 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15709 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015710 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015712req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15713 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15714 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15715 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15716 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15717 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15718 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15719 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15720 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015722req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15723 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15724 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15725 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15726 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015728req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15729 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15730 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15731 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15732 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15733 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15734 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15735 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15736 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015737 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015738 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015739 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015741 ACL derivatives :
15742 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15743 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15744 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15745 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15746 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15747 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15748 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15749 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15750
15751req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15752hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15753 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15754 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15755 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15756 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15757 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15758 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15759 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15760 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15761 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15762
15763req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15764hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15765 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15766 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15767 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15768 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15769 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015770 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015771 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15772 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15773
15774req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15775hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15776 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15777 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15778 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15779 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15780 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15781 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15782 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15783
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010015784
15785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015786http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15787 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15788 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15789 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15790 basic auth is supported.
15791
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015792http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15793 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15794 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15795 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15796 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015797 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15798 basic auth is supported.
15799
15800 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015801 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15802 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15803 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15804 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015805
15806http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015807 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
15808 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015809 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
15810 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015812method : integer + string
15813 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
15814 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
15815 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
15816 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
15817 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
15818 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
15819 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015821 ACL derivatives :
15822 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015824 Example :
15825 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
15826 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
15827 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015829path : string
15830 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
15831 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
15832 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
15833 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
15834 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015835 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015836 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015838 ACL derivatives :
15839 path : exact string match
15840 path_beg : prefix match
15841 path_dir : subdir match
15842 path_dom : domain match
15843 path_end : suffix match
15844 path_len : length match
15845 path_reg : regex match
15846 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015847
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015848query : string
15849 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
15850 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
15851 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
15852 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015853 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015854 which stops before the question mark.
15855
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015856req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15857 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15858 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15859 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15860 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015862req.ver : string
15863req_ver : string (deprecated)
15864 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
15865 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
15866 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015868 ACL derivatives :
15869 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015871res.comp : boolean
15872 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
15873 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
15874 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015876res.comp_algo : string
15877 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
15878 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
15879 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015881res.cook([<name>]) : string
15882scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15883 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15884 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15885 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015887 ACL derivatives :
15888 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015890res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15891scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15892 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15893 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
15894 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015896res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15897scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15898 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15899 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
15900 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015902res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15903 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15904 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15905 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15906 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15907 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
15908 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
15909 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
15910 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
15911 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015913res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15914 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15915 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15916 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15917 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
15918 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015920res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15921shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
15922 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15923 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15924 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15925 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15926 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
15927 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
15928 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
15929 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015931 ACL derivatives :
15932 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15933 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15934 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15935 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15936 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15937 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15938 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15939 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15940
15941res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15942shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15943 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15944 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15945 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
15946 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
15947 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015949res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15950shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15951 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
15952 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
15953 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
15954 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
15955 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
15956 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015957
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015958res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15959 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15960 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15961 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15962 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015964res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15965shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15966 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
15967 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15968 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
15969 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
15970 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
15971 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015973res.ver : string
15974resp_ver : string (deprecated)
15975 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
15976 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015978 ACL derivatives :
15979 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015981set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15982 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15983 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015984 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015985 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015987 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
15988 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015990status : integer
15991 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
15992 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
15993 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015994
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020015995unique-id : string
15996 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
15997 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
15998 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
15999 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16000 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16001 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016003url : string
16004 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16005 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16006 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16007 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16008 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16009 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16010 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016012 ACL derivatives :
16013 url : exact string match
16014 url_beg : prefix match
16015 url_dir : subdir match
16016 url_dom : domain match
16017 url_end : suffix match
16018 url_len : length match
16019 url_reg : regex match
16020 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016022url_ip : ip
16023 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16024 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16025 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16026 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16027 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16028 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16029 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016031url_port : integer
16032 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16033 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16034 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16035 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016036
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016037urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16038url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016039 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16040 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016041 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16042 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16043 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16044 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016045 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16046 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016047 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16048 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016050 ACL derivatives :
16051 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16052 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16053 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16054 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16055 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16056 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16057 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16058 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016059
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016061 Example :
16062 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16063 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16064 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16065 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016066
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016067urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016068 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16069 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16070 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016071
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016072url32 : integer
16073 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16074 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16075 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16076 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16077 is an unsigned integer.
16078
16079url32+src : binary
16080 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16081 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16082 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16083
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200160857.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016086---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016087
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016088Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16089every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016090order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016092ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16093---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016094FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016095HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016096HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16097HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016098HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16099HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16100HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16101HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16102LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016103METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016104METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016105METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16106METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16107METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16108METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016109METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016110METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016111RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016112REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016113TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016114WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16115---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016116
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016117
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161188. Logging
16119----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016120
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016121One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16122provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16123very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16124provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16125state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016126to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016127headers.
16128
16129In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16130about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16131send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16132
16133 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16134 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16135 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16136 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16137 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016138 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016139 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016140
16141The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16142allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16143as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16144while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16145real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16146delay.
16147
16148
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161498.1. Log levels
16150---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016151
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016152TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016153source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016154HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16155in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16156track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16157syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16158about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016159
16160
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161618.2. Log formats
16162----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016163
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016164HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016165and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16166slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16167options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016168
16169 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16170 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16171 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16172 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16173 extents.
16174
16175 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16176 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16177 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16178 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16179 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16180
16181 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16182 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16183 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16184 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16185 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16186
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016187 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16188 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16189 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16190 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16191
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016192 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16193
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016194Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16195specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16196field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16197servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16198always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16199identifier.
16200
16201Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16202 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16203 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16204 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16205 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16206
16207
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162088.2.1. Default log format
16209-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016210
16211This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16212as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16213format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16214
16215 Example :
16216 listen www
16217 mode http
16218 log global
16219 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16220
16221 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16222 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16223 (www/HTTP)
16224
16225 Field Format Extract from the example above
16226 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16227 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16228 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16229 4 'to' to
16230 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16231 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16232
16233Detailed fields description :
16234 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16235 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16236 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16237 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16238 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16239 and processed the connection.
16240 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16241
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016242In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16243"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16244connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16245
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016246It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16247will eventually disappear.
16248
16249
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162508.2.2. TCP log format
16251---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016252
16253The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16254is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16255information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16256counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16257emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16258environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16259the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16260sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016261specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16262not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16263fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16264marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016265
16266 Example :
16267 frontend fnt
16268 mode tcp
16269 option tcplog
16270 log global
16271 default_backend bck
16272
16273 backend bck
16274 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16275
16276 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16277 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16278 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16279
16280 Field Format Extract from the example above
16281 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16282 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16283 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16284 4 frontend_name fnt
16285 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16286 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16287 7 bytes_read* 212
16288 8 termination_state --
16289 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16290 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16291
16292Detailed fields description :
16293 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016294 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16295 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16296 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016297 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016298 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016299 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016300
16301 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016302 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16303 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16304 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016305
16306 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16307 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16308 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016309 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16310 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16311 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16312 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016313
16314 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16315 and processed the connection.
16316
16317 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16318 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16319 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16320 applications.
16321
16322 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16323 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16324 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16325 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16326 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16327
16328 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16329 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16330 See "Timers" below for more details.
16331
16332 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16333 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16334 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16335 "Timers" below for more details.
16336
16337 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016338 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016339 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16340 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16341 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16342 details.
16343
16344 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16345 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16346 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16347 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16348 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16349
16350 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16351 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16352 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16353 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16354 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16355 for more details.
16356
16357 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016358 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016359 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16360 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16361 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016362 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016363
16364 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16365 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16366 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16367 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16368 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16369 caused by a denial of service attack.
16370
16371 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16372 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16373 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16374 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16375 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16376 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16377 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16378 denial of service attack.
16379
16380 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16381 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16382 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16383 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16384 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16385 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16386 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16387 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16388 be processed than on other servers.
16389
16390 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16391 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16392 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16393 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16394 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16395 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16396 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16397 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16398 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16399 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16400 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16401 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16402 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16403
16404 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16405 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16406 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16407 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16408 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16409 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016410 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016411 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16412
16413 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16414 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16415 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16416 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16417 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16418 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016419 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016420 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16421 occurs.
16422
16423
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164248.2.3. HTTP log format
16425----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016426
16427The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16428is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16429the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16430are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16431emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16432generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16433"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16434which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016435frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16436is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016437
16438Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16439slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16440with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16441
16442 Example :
16443 frontend http-in
16444 mode http
16445 option httplog
16446 log global
16447 default_backend bck
16448
16449 backend static
16450 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16451
16452 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16453 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16454 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016455 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016456
16457 Field Format Extract from the example above
16458 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16459 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016460 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016461 4 frontend_name http-in
16462 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016463 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016464 7 status_code 200
16465 8 bytes_read* 2750
16466 9 captured_request_cookie -
16467 10 captured_response_cookie -
16468 11 termination_state ----
16469 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16470 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16471 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16472 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16473 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016474
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016475Detailed fields description :
16476 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016477 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16478 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16479 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016480 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016481 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016482 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016483
16484 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016485 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16486 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16487 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016488
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016489 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16490 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016491
16492 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16493 and processed the connection.
16494
16495 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16496 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16497 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16498
16499 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16500 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16501 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16502 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16503 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16504 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16505
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016506 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16507 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16508 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016509 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016510 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16511 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016512 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16513 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016514
16515 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16516 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016517 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016518
16519 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16520 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016521 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16522 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016523
16524 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16525 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16526 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16527 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16528 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016529 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16530 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016531
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016532 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16533 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16534 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16535 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16536 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16537 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16538 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016539 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016540
16541 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16542 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16543 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16544
16545 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16546 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016547 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016548 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16549 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16550 overflowing.
16551
16552 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16553 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16554 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16555 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16556 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16557 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16558 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16559 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16560
16561 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16562 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16563 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16564 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16565 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16566 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16567 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16568 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16569
16570 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16571 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16572 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16573 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16574 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16575 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16576 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16577
16578 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016579 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016580 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16581 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16582 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016583 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016584 system.
16585
16586 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16587 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16588 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16589 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16590 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16591 caused by a denial of service attack.
16592
16593 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16594 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16595 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16596 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16597 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16598 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16599 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16600 denial of service attack.
16601
16602 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16603 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16604 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16605 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16606 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16607 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16608 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16609 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16610 processed than on other servers.
16611
16612 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16613 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16614 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16615 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16616 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16617 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16618 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16619 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16620 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16621 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16622 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16623 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16624 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16625
16626 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16627 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16628 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16629 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16630 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16631 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016632 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016633 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16634
16635 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16636 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16637 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16638 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16639 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16640 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016641 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016642 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16643 occurs.
16644
16645 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16646 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16647 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16648 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16649 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16650 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16651 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16652 cookies" below for more details.
16653
16654 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16655 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16656 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16657 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16658 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16659 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16660 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16661 and cookies" below for more details.
16662
16663 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16664 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16665 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16666 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16667 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16668 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16669 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16670 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16671
16672
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200166738.2.4. Custom log format
16674------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016675
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016676The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016677mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016678
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016679HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016680Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16681separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16682prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16683
16684Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16685variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016686("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016687
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016688If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016689as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016690less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16691the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16692
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016693Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016694In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016695in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016696
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016697Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16698'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16699https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16700such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16701
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016702Flags are :
16703 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016704 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016705 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16706 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016707
16708 Example:
16709
16710 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16711 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16712
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016713 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16714
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016715At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16716
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016717 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16718 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016719
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016720the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016721
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016722 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16723 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16724 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016725
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016726and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16727
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016728 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16729 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016730
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016731Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16732
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016733 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016734 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016735 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16736 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16737 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016738 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16739 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16740 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016741 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016742 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16743 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016744 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016745 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16746 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016747 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016748 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016749 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016750 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016751 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016752 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016753 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016754 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16755 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16756 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16757 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16758 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016759 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016760 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16761 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016762 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016763 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16764 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016765 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16766 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16767 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016768 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016769 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16770 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016771 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016772 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16773 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16774 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016775 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016776 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016777 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16778 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16779 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16780 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016781 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016782 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016783 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016784 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016785 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016786 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016787 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16788 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16789 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016790 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016791 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16792 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016793 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016794 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16795 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020016796 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016797 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016798 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016799 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016800
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016801 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016802
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016803
168048.2.5. Error log format
16805-----------------------
16806
16807When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
16808protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
16809By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
16810"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016811will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016812logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
16813
16814The format looks like this :
16815
16816 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
16817 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
16818 Connection error during SSL handshake
16819
16820 Field Format Extract from the example above
16821 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
16822 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
16823 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
16824 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
16825 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
16826
16827These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
16828failures.
16829
16830
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168318.3. Advanced logging options
16832-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016833
16834Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
16835just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
16836options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
16837for more information about their usage.
16838
16839
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168408.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
16841------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016842
16843It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
16844haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
16845commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
16846monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
16847ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
16848
16849 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
16850 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
16851 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
16852 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
16853
16854 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
16855 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
16856 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016857 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016858 such as other load-balancers.
16859
16860 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
16861 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
16862 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
16863
16864
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168658.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
16866----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016867
16868The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
16869what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
16870or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016871"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016872just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
16873log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
16874after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
16875is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
16876with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
16877with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
16878
16879
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168808.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
16881------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016882
16883Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
16884for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
16885"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
16886retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
16887raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
16888a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
16889file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
16890you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
16891"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
16892
16893
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168948.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
16895--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016896
16897Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
16898multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
16899them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
16900"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
16901logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
16902error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
16903and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
16904too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
16905useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
16906alternative.
16907
16908
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169098.4. Timing events
16910------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016911
16912Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
16913reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
16914the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
16915frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016916mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
16917addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
16918
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010016919Timings events in HTTP mode:
16920
16921 first request 2nd request
16922 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
16923 t tr t tr ...
16924 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
16925 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
16926 :<---- Tq ---->: :
16927 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
16928 :<--------- Ta --------->:
16929
16930Timings events in TCP mode:
16931
16932 TCP session
16933 |<----------------->|
16934 t t
16935 ---|----|----|----|----|---
16936 | Th Tw Tc Td |
16937 |<------ Tt ------->|
16938
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016939 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016940 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016941 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
16942 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
16943 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016944 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016945 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
16946 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
16947 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
16948 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016949
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016950 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
16951 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
16952 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016953 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
16954 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
16955 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
16956 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
16957 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
16958 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016959
16960 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
16961 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
16962 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
16963 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
16964 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
16965 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
16966 request typed by hand during a test.
16967
16968 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
16969 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016970 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016971 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
16972 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
16973 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
16974 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016975
16976 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
16977 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
16978 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
16979 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
16980 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
16981
16982 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
16983 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
16984 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
16985 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
16986 connection never established.
16987
16988 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
16989 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
16990 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
16991 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
16992 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
16993 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
16994 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
16995 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
16996 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
16997 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
16998 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
16999
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017000 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17001 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17002 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17003 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17004 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17005 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17006
17007 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17008
17009 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17010 "Ta" can never be negative.
17011
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017012 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17013 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017014 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17015 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017016 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017017
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017018 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017019
17020 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017021 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17022 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017023
17024These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17025protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17026that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017027due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17028"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17029that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017030
17031Most common cases :
17032
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017033 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17034 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17035 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17036 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17037 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17038 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17039 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17040 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17041 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17042 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17043 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017044 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017045
17046 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17047 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17048 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17049 of ms on remote networks.
17050
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017051 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17052 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17053 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017054
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017055 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17056 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17057 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17058 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17059 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17060 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17061 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17062 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17063 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017064
17065Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17066
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017067 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017068 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017069 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017070
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017071 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017072 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17073 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17074
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017075 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017076 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17077 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17078 flags.
17079
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017080 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17081 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017082 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17083 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17084 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17085 the client connection was maintained open.
17086
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017087 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017088 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017089 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017090 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17091
17092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170938.5. Session state at disconnection
17094-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017095
17096TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17097"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
170982-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17099each of which has a special meaning :
17100
17101 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17102 session to terminate :
17103
17104 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17105
17106 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17107 server explicitly refused it.
17108
17109 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17110 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17111 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17112 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017113 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017114
17115 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17116 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017117
17118 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17119 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17120 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17121 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17122 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17123
17124 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17125 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17126 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17127 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17128 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17129
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017130 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17131 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17132
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017133 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17134 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17135 backup connections when going up.
17136
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017137 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17138
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017139 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17140 send or receive data.
17141
17142 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17143 send or receive data.
17144
17145 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17146 with nothing left in the buffers.
17147
17148 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17149
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017150 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017151 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17152
17153 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17154 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17155 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17156 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17157 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17158
17159 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17160 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17161
17162 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17163 server (HTTP only).
17164
17165 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17166
17167 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17168 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17169 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17170
17171 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17172 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17173 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17174
17175 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17176
17177 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17178 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17179
17180 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17181 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17182 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17183
17184 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17185 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017186 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17187 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017188
17189 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17190 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17191 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17192 another server.
17193
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017194 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017195 server.
17196
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017197 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17198 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17199 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17200 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17201
17202 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17203 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17204 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17205 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17206
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017207 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17208 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17209 "use-server" rule).
17210
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017211 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17212
17213 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17214 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17215
17216 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17217
17218 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17219 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17220 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17221
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017222 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17223 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017224 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017225 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17226 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17227
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017228 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17229
17230 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17231 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17232
17233 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17234
17235 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17236
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017237The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17238was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017239helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17240starvation, attacks, etc...
17241
17242The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17243alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17244easier finding and understanding.
17245
17246 Flags Reason
17247
17248 -- Normal termination.
17249
17250 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17251 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17252 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17253 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17254
17255 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17256 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17257 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17258 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17259 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17260 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017261
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017262 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17263 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017264 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017265
17266 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17267 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17268 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17269
17270 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17271 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17272 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17273 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17274 the server takes too long to respond.
17275
17276 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17277 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17278 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17279 long a time to respond.
17280
17281 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17282 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17283 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17284 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017285 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17286 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017287
17288 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17289 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17290 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17291 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17292 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017293 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017294 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17295 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17296 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17297 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17298 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17299 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17300 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17301 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017302 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017303 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17304 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17305 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017306
17307 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17308 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017309 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17310 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17311 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17312 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017313
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017314 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17315 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17316
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017317 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017318 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17319 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017320 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017321 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17322 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17323
17324 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17325 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17326 503 or 504 here.
17327
17328 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17329 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17330 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17331 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17332 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17333
17334 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17335 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017336 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017337 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17338 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17339
17340 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17341 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17342 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17343 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17344 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17345 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17346 between haproxy and the server.
17347
17348 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17349 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17350 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17351 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17352 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17353 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17354 solution is to fix the application.
17355
17356 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17357 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17358 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17359 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17360 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17361 external attacks.
17362
17363 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17364 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017365 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017366 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17367 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17368
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017369 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17370 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17371 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017372 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017373 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017374
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017375 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17376 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17377 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17378 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017379 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17380 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17381 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17382 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17383 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017384
17385 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17386 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17387 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17388 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17389
17390 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17391 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17392 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17393 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17394
17395 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17396 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17397 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17398 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17399
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017400The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17401persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17402important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17403re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17404
17405 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17406
17407 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17408 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17409 set on a GET request.
17410
17411 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17412 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017413 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017414 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17415
17416 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17417 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17418 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17419
17420 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17421 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17422 already got a cookie.
17423
17424 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17425 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17426 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17427 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17428 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17429
17430 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17431 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17432 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17433
17434 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17435 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17436 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17437
17438 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17439 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17440
17441 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17442 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17443 then advertised in the response.
17444
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017445
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174468.6. Non-printable characters
17447-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017448
17449In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17450consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17451converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17452prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17453being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17454escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17455is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17456'}' when logging headers.
17457
17458Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17459issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17460containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17461
17462Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17463the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17464performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17465
17466
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174678.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17468---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017469
17470Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17471achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017472section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017473cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17474the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17475the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017476locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017477not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17478user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17479a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17480wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17481
17482 Examples :
17483 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17484 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17485
17486 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17487 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17488
17489
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174908.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17491---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017492
17493Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17494proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17495the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17496server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17497
17498Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17499response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017500section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017501
17502It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017503time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17504appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017505are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17506and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17507follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17508request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17509in the logs.
17510
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017511As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17512frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17513an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17514
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017515 Example :
17516 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17517 listen proxy-out
17518 mode http
17519 option httplog
17520 option logasap
17521 log global
17522 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17523
17524 # log the name of the virtual server
17525 capture request header Host len 20
17526
17527 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17528 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17529
17530 # log the beginning of the referrer
17531 capture request header Referer len 20
17532
17533 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17534 capture response header Server len 20
17535
17536 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17537 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17538
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017539 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017540 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17541
17542 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17543 capture response header Via len 20
17544
17545 # log the URL location during a redirection
17546 capture response header Location len 20
17547
17548 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17549 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17550 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17551 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17552 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17553
17554 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17555 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17556 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17557 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017558 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017559
17560 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17561 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17562 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17563 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17564 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017565 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017566
17567
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175688.9. Examples of logs
17569---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017570
17571These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17572them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17573reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17574
17575 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17576 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17577 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17578
17579 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17580 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17581
17582 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17583 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17584 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17585
17586 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17587 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17588
17589 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17590 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17591 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17592
17593 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017594 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017595 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17596 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17597
17598 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17599 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17600 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17601
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017602 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
17603 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
17604 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
17605 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
17606 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
17607 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017608
17609 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017610 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017611
17612 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17613 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17614 Nothing was sent to any server.
17615
17616 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17617 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17618
17619 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17620 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017621 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017622 send a 408 return code to the client.
17623
17624 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17625 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17626
17627 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17628 5 seconds ("c----").
17629
17630 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17631 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017632 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017633
17634 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017635 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017636 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17637 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17638 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17639 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17640 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017641
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017642
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200176439. Supported filters
17644--------------------
17645
17646Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17647accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17648unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17649
17650See also : "filter"
17651
176529.1. Trace
17653----------
17654
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017655filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017656
17657 Arguments:
17658 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17659 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17660
17661 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17662 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17663 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17664 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17665
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017666 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017667 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17668 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17669 amount of the parsed data.
17670
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017671 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017672
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017673This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17674callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17675information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17676filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17677
17678Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17679tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17680a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17681
17682
176839.2. HTTP compression
17684---------------------
17685
17686filter compression
17687
17688The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17689keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017690when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
17691it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
17692response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
17693line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
17694cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
17695the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017696
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017697See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017698
17699
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200177009.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17701--------------------------------------------
17702
17703filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17704
17705 Arguments :
17706
17707 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17708 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17709 parsed.
17710
17711 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17712 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17713 part must be placed in its own scope.
17714
17715The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17716external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017717streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017718exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17719also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17720
17721SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17722the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17723
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017724For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017725"doc/SPOE.txt".
17726
17727Important note:
17728 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17729 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17730
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100177319.4. Cache
17732----------
17733
17734filter cache <name>
17735
17736 Arguments :
17737
17738 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
17739
17740The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
17741"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017742cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017743other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
17744the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
17745mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
17746filter other than the compression is used for the same
17747listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17748order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017749
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017750See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 6 about cache.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017751
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017752/*
17753 * Local variables:
17754 * fill-column: 79
17755 * End:
17756 */